blob: 78439aab2b5b882cc496694415c220129387a68d [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau2e077f82019-11-25 20:36:16 +01005 version 2.2
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau4462af82020-06-26 22:01:04 +02007 2020/06/26
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200543.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100553.8. HTTP-errors
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +0200563.9. Rings
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020057
584. Proxies
594.1. Proxy keywords matrix
604.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
61
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100625. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200635.1. Bind options
645.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200655.3. Server DNS resolution
665.3.1. Global overview
675.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020068
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100696. Cache
706.1. Limitation
716.2. Setup
726.2.1. Cache section
736.2.2. Proxy section
74
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200757. Using ACLs and fetching samples
767.1. ACL basics
777.1.1. Matching booleans
787.1.2. Matching integers
797.1.3. Matching strings
807.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
817.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
827.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
837.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
847.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200857.3.1. Converters
867.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
877.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
887.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
897.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
907.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200917.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200927.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020093
948. Logging
958.1. Log levels
968.2. Log formats
978.2.1. Default log format
988.2.2. TCP log format
998.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01001008.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +01001018.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001028.3. Advanced logging options
1038.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1048.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1058.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1068.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1078.4. Timing events
1088.5. Session state at disconnection
1098.6. Non-printable characters
1108.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1118.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1128.9. Examples of logs
113
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001149. Supported filters
1159.1. Trace
1169.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001179.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001189.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001199.5. fcgi-app
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200120
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012110. FastCGI applications
12210.1. Setup
12310.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12410.1.2. Proxy section
12510.1.3. Example
12610.2. Default parameters
12710.3. Limitations
128
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200129
1301. Quick reminder about HTTP
131----------------------------
132
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100133When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200134fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
135on almost anything found in the contents.
136
137However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
138formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
139correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
140
141
1421.1. The HTTP transaction model
143-------------------------------
144
145The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100146to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100147from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
148connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200149will involve a new connection :
150
151 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
152
153In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
154establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
155by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
156length.
157
158Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
159to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
160however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
161response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
162header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
163
164 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
165
166Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
167power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
168but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200169a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200170
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100171Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200172keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
173second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
174page :
175
176 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
177
178This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
179latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
180correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
181the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100182server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200183
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100184The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
185time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
186are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
187parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
188carry the stream identifier.
189
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100190By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
191connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
192leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100193start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
194processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
195waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200196
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200197HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100198 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
199 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100200 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100201 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200202 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100203
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100204For HTTP/2, the connection mode resembles more the "server close" mode : given
205the independence of all streams, there is currently no place to hook the idle
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100206server connection after a response, so it is closed after the response. HTTP/2
207is only supported for incoming connections, not on connections going to
208servers.
209
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200210
2111.2. HTTP request
212-----------------
213
214First, let's consider this HTTP request :
215
216 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100217 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200218 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
219 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
220 3 User-agent: my small browser
221 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
222 5 Accept: image/png
223
224
2251.2.1. The Request line
226-----------------------
227
228Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
229
230 - a METHOD : GET
231 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
232 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
233
234All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
235which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
236followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
237is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
238desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
239the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
240
241The URI itself can have several forms :
242
243 - A "relative URI" :
244
245 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
246
247 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
248 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
249
250 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
251
252 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
253
254 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
255 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
256 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
257 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
258 must accept this form too.
259
260 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
261 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
262 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100263
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200264 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
265 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
266 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
267 other protocols too.
268
269In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
270mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
271on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
272It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
273specific to the language, framework or application in use.
274
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100275HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100276assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100277However, haproxy natively processes HTTP/1.x requests and headers, so requests
278received over an HTTP/2 connection are transcoded to HTTP/1.1 before being
279processed. This explains why they still appear as "HTTP/1.1" in haproxy's logs
280as well as in server logs.
281
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200282
2831.2.2. The request headers
284--------------------------
285
286The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
287beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
288an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
289Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
290values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
291encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
292the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
293define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
294
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100295Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200296their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100297"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
298as can be seen when running in debug mode.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200299
300The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
301that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
302is one valid form of empty line.
303
304Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
305headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
306about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
307application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
308
309Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000310 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200311 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
312 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
313 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
314
315
3161.3. HTTP response
317------------------
318
319An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
320messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
321
322 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100323 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200324 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
325 2 Content-length: 350
326 3 Content-Type: text/html
327
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200328As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
329codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
330response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100331continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
332the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
333following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
334sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
335(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
336correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
337such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
338state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
339over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
340if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
341information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200342
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200343
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003441.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200345------------------------
346
347Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
348
349 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
350 - a status code : 200
351 - a reason : OK
352
353The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100354 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
355 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
356 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
357 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
358 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200359
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000360Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100361"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200362found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
363messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
364or "Authentication Required".
365
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100366HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200367
368 Code When / reason
369 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
370 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
371 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
372 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100373 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
374 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200375 400 for an invalid or too large request
376 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
377 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200378 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100379 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200380 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100381 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
382 be available again
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200383 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
384 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
385 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200386 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200387 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
388 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
389 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
390
391The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3924.2).
393
394
3951.3.2. The response headers
396---------------------------
397
398Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
399the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
400details.
401
402
4032. Configuring HAProxy
404----------------------
405
4062.1. Configuration file format
407------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200408
409HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
410
411 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
412 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
413 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
414 "frontend" and "backend".
415
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100416The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
417referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200418delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100419
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200420
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004212.2. Quoting and escaping
422-------------------------
423
424HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
425many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
426with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
427single quotes.
428
429If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
430them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
431escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
432
433Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
434
435 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
436 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
437 \\ to use a backslash
438 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
439 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
440
441Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
442the interpretation of:
443
444 space as a parameter separator
445 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
446 # hash as a comment start
447
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200448Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
449-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
450backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
451
452Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200453quoting.
454
455Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
456nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
457
458Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
459equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
460
461 Example:
462 # those are equivalents:
463 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
464 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
465 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
466 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
467 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
468
469 # those are equivalents:
470 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
471 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
472 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
473 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
474
475
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004762.3. Environment variables
477--------------------------
478
479HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
480interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
481configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
482optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
483shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
484underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
485
486 Example:
487
488 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
489
490 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
491
492 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
493
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200494Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
495file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200496
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200497* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
498 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
499
500* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
501 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
502 directory.
503
504* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
505
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500506* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200507 processes, separated by semicolons.
508
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500509* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200510 CLI, separated by semicolons.
511
512See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200513
5142.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200515----------------
516
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100517Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100518values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
519otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
520numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
521for every keyword. Supported units are :
522
523 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
524 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
525 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
526 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
527 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
528 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
529
530
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00005312.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200532-------------
533
534 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
535 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
536 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
537 global
538 daemon
539 maxconn 256
540
541 defaults
542 mode http
543 timeout connect 5000ms
544 timeout client 50000ms
545 timeout server 50000ms
546
547 frontend http-in
548 bind *:80
549 default_backend servers
550
551 backend servers
552 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
553
554
555 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
556 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
557 global
558 daemon
559 maxconn 256
560
561 defaults
562 mode http
563 timeout connect 5000ms
564 timeout client 50000ms
565 timeout server 50000ms
566
567 listen http-in
568 bind *:80
569 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
570
571
572Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
573
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100574 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200575
576
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005773. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200578--------------------
579
580Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
581are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
582of them have command-line equivalents.
583
584The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
585
586 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200587 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200588 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200589 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200590 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200591 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200592 - description
593 - deviceatlas-json-file
594 - deviceatlas-log-level
595 - deviceatlas-separator
596 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900597 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200598 - gid
599 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100600 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200601 - h1-case-adjust
602 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100603 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100604 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100605 - issuers-chain-path
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +0200606 - localpeer
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200607 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200608 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100609 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200610 - lua-load
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +0100611 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200612 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200613 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200614 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200615 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200616 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +0200617 - pp2-never-send-local
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100618 - presetenv
619 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200620 - uid
621 - ulimit-n
622 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +0200623 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100624 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200625 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200626 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200627 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +0200628 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200629 - ssl-default-bind-options
630 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200631 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200632 - ssl-default-server-options
633 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100634 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +0200635 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100636 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100637 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100638 - 51degrees-data-file
639 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200640 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200641 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200642 - wurfl-data-file
643 - wurfl-information-list
644 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200645 - wurfl-cache-size
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +0100646 - strict-limits
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100647
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200648 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +0100649 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200650 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200651 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200652 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100653 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100654 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100655 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200656 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200657 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200658 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200659 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200660 - noepoll
661 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +0000662 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200663 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100664 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300665 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000666 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100667 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200668 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200669 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200670 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000671 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000672 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200673 - tune.buffers.limit
674 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200675 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200676 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100677 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +0200678 - tune.fd.edge-triggered
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200679 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200680 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200681 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100682 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200683 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200684 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100685 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100686 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100687 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100688 - tune.lua.session-timeout
689 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200690 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100691 - tune.maxaccept
692 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200693 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200694 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200695 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100696 - tune.rcvbuf.client
697 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100698 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +0200699 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +0200700 - tune.sched.low-latency
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100701 - tune.sndbuf.client
702 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100703 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100704 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200705 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100706 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200707 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200708 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100709 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200710 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100711 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200712 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
713 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
714 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100715 - tune.zlib.memlevel
716 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100717
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200718 * Debugging
719 - debug
720 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +0200721 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200722
723
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007243.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200725------------------------------------
726
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200727ca-base <dir>
728 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +0100729 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
730 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
731 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200732
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200733chroot <jail dir>
734 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
735 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
736 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
737 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
738 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100739 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100740
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100741cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
742 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
743 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
744 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
745 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
746 set. These sets have the format
747
748 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
749
750 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100751 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100752 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
753 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100754 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
755 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100756 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +0100757 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100758 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100759 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100760 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
761 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
762 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
763 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100764
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +0100765 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
766 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
767 on the machine's word size.
768
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100769 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100770 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
771 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
772 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
773 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
774 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
775 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100776
777 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100778 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
779
780 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
781 # first 4 CPUs
782
783 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
784 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
785 # word size.
786
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100787 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100788 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100789 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
790 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
791 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
792
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100793 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
794 # and so on.
795 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
796 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
797 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
798
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100799 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +0100800 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
801 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
802 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
803
804 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
805 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
806 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
807
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +0100808 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
809 # and a thread range.
810 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
811 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
812 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
813
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200814crt-base <dir>
815 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +0100816 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
817 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200818
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200819daemon
820 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
821 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +0100822 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
823 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200824
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200825deviceatlas-json-file <path>
826 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100827 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200828
829deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100830 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200831 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
832
833deviceatlas-separator <char>
834 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
835 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
836
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100837deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200838 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
839 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
840 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100841
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900842external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100843 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
844 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100845 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
846 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
847 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
848 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
849 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900850
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200851gid <number>
852 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
853 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
854 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100855 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
856 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200857 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100858
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +0100859group <group name>
860 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
861 See also "gid" and "user".
862
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100863hard-stop-after <time>
864 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
865
866 Arguments :
867 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
868 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
869 SIGUSR1 signal.
870
871 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
872 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
873 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
874
875 Example:
876 global
877 hard-stop-after 30s
878
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200879h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
880 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
881 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
882 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
883 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +0500884 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200885 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
886 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
887 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
888 specified in a proxy.
889
890 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
891 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
892 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
893 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
894 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
895 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
896 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
897
898 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
899 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
900 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
901 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
902 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
903
904 Example:
905 global
906 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
907
908 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
909 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
910
911h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
912 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
913 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
914 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
915 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
916 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
917 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
918 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
919 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
920
921 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
922 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
923 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
924
925 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
926 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
927
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100928insecure-fork-wanted
929 By default haproxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
930 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
931 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
932 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
933 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
934 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
935 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
936 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
937 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within haproxy itself
938 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
939 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
940 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
941 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
942 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
943 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
944 disable it.
945
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100946insecure-setuid-wanted
947 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
948 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
949 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
950 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
951 aware of the risks. In a situation where haproxy would need to call external
952 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
953 haproxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
954 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
955 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
956 escalation in such a situation. This is what haproxy does by default. In case
957 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
958 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
959 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
960 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
961
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100962issuers-chain-path <dir>
963 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
964 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
965 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
966 intermediate certificate), haproxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
967 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
968 "issuers-chain-path".
969 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
970 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
971 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
972 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
973 will share the chain in memory.
974
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +0200975localpeer <name>
976 Sets the local instance's peer name. It will be ignored if the "-L"
977 command line argument is specified or if used after "peers" section
978 definitions. In such cases, a warning message will be emitted during
979 the configuration parsing.
980
981 This option will also set the HAPROXY_LOCALPEER environment variable.
982 See also "-L" in the management guide and "peers" section below.
983
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +0200984log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
985 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +0100986 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100987 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100988 configured with "log global".
989
990 <address> can be one of:
991
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100992 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100993 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
994 port).
995
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100996 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
997 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
998 port).
999
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001000 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001001 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
1002 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001003 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001004
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001005 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
1006 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
1007 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
1008 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
1009 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
1010 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
1011 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
1012 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
1013 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1014 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
1015 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
1016 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1017 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1018 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001019 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1020 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001021
1022 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1023 "fd@2", see above.
1024
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001025 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1026 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1027 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1028 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1029 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1030
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001031 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1032 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001033
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001034 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1035 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1036 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1037 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1038 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1039 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1040 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1041 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1042 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1043 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001044 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1045 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001046
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001047 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1048 one of the following :
1049
1050 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
1051 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1052
1053 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1054 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1055
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001056 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1057 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1058 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1059 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1060 logger consumes.
1061
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001062 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1063 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1064 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1065 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1066
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001067 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1068 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1069 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1070 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1071 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1072
1073 <sample_size>
1074 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1075 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1076 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1077 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1078 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1079
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001080 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001081
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001082 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1083 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1084 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1085
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001086 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1087 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1088 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1089 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001090
1091 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001092 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1093 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1094 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1095 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1096 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1097 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001098
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001099 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001100
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001101log-send-hostname [<string>]
1102 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1103 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1104 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1105 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1106 the logs.
1107
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001108log-tag <string>
1109 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1110 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1111 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001112 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001113
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001114lua-load <file>
1115 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
1116 used multiple times.
1117
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001118lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1119 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1120 variable.
1121 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1122 to "path".
1123
1124 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1125 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1126 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1127 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1128 will be checked earlier.
1129
1130 As an example by specifying the following path:
1131
1132 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1133 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1134
1135 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1136 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1137 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1138 paths if that does not exist either.
1139
1140 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1141 documentation.
1142
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001143master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001144 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1145 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1146 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001147 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001148 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1149 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001150 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1151 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1152 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1153 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1154 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001155
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001156 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001157
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001158mworker-max-reloads <number>
1159 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001160 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001161 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1162 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1163 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1164
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001165nbproc <number>
1166 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1167 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1168 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001169 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1170 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreau1f672a82019-01-26 14:20:55 +01001171 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon" and
1172 "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001173
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001174nbthread <number>
1175 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001176 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
1177 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1178 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1179 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1180 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001181 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1182 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1183 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1184 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1185 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1186 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1187 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001188
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001189pidfile <pidfile>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001190 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001191 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
1192 starting the process. See also "daemon".
1193
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001194pp2-never-send-local
1195 A bug in the PROXY protocol v2 implementation was present in HAProxy up to
1196 version 2.1, causing it to emit a PROXY command instead of a LOCAL command
1197 for health checks. This is particularly minor but confuses some servers'
1198 logs. Sadly, the bug was discovered very late and revealed that some servers
1199 which possibly only tested their PROXY protocol implementation against
1200 HAProxy fail to properly handle the LOCAL command, and permanently remain in
1201 the "down" state when HAProxy checks them. When this happens, it is possible
1202 to enable this global option to revert to the older (bogus) behavior for the
1203 time it takes to contact the affected components' vendors and get them fixed.
1204 This option is disabled by default and acts on all servers having the
1205 "send-proxy-v2" statement.
1206
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001207presetenv <name> <value>
1208 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1209 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1210 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1211 and "unsetenv".
1212
1213resetenv [<name> ...]
1214 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1215 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1216 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1217 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1218 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1219 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1220 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1221 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1222
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001223stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001224 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1225 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1226 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1227 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1228 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1229 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001230 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001231 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1232 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1233 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1234 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001235
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001236server-state-base <directory>
1237 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001238 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1239 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001240
1241server-state-file <file>
1242 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1243 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1244 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1245 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1246 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1247 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1248 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1249 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001250 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1251 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001252
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001253setenv <name> <value>
1254 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1255 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1256 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1257 and "unsetenv".
1258
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001259set-dumpable
1260 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001261 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1262 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1263 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1264 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1265 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1266 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1267 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1268 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1269 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1270 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1271 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1272 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1273 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1274 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1275 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
1276 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it
1277 leaves a core where expected when dying.
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001278
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001279ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1280 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1281 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001282 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001283 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001284 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1285 information and recommendations see e.g.
1286 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1287 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1288 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1289 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001290
1291ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1292 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1293 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1294 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1295 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1296 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001297 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1298 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1299 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001300 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001301
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001302ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
1303 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1304 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
1305 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
1306 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
1307 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
1308
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001309ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1310 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1311 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1312 keyword to see available options.
1313
1314 Example:
1315 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001316 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001317
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001318ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1319 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1320 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001321 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001322 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001323 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1324 information and recommendations see e.g.
1325 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1326 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1327 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1328 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1329 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001330
1331ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1332 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1333 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1334 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1335 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1336 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001337 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1338 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1339 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1340 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001341
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001342ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1343 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1344 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1345 keyword to see available options.
1346
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001347ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1348 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1349 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1350 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001351 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001352 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001353 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1354 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1355 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1356 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001357 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1358 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1359 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1360
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001361ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001362 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
1363 the loading of the SSL certificates.
1364
1365 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
1366 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
1367 optimize the startup time.
1368
1369 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
1370 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
1371 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
1372
1373 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001374 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001375
1376 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
1377 will try to load a certificate bundle. This is done by looking for
1378 <basename>.rsa, .ecdsa and .dsa. In the case of directories, HAProxy will
1379 try to gather the files with the same basename in a multi-certificate bundle.
1380 The bundles were introduced with OpenSSL 1.0.2 and were the only way back
1381 then to load an ECDSA certificate and a RSA one, with the same SNI. Since
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05001382 OpenSSL 1.1.1 it is not recommended anymore, you can specify both the ECDSA
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001383 and the RSA file on the bind line.
1384
1385 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword.
1386
1387 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword.
1388
1389 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
1390 not provided in the PEM file.
1391
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001392 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
1393 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
1394
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001395 The default behavior is "all".
1396
1397 Example:
1398 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
1399 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
1400 ssl-load-extra-files none
1401
1402 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options.
1403
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001404ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1405 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1406 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1407 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1408
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001409ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
1410 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the enchor for chain validation: as a
1411 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
1412 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
1413 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
1414 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
1415 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
1416 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
1417 bits does not need it.
1418
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001419stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1420 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1421 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1422 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001423 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001424 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001425
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001426 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1427 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1428 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001429
1430stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1431 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1432 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001433 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001434
1435stats maxconn <connections>
1436 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1437 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1438
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001439uid <number>
1440 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
1441 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1442 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1443 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1444
1445ulimit-n <number>
1446 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1447 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1448 option.
1449
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001450unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1451 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1452
1453 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1454 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1455 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1456 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1457 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1458 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1459 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1460 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1461 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1462 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1463
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001464unsetenv [<name> ...]
1465 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1466 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1467 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1468 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1469 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1470 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1471 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1472
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001473user <user name>
1474 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1475 See also "uid" and "group".
1476
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001477node <name>
1478 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1479
1480 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1481 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1482 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1483 traffic.
1484
1485description <text>
1486 Add a text that describes the instance.
1487
1488 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1489 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1490 "<" and ">" characters.
1491
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100149251degrees-data-file <file path>
1493 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001494 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001495
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001496 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001497 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1498
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000149951degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001500 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1501 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1502 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1503
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001504 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001505 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1506
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200150751degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001508 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1509 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1510
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001511 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1512 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1513
151451degrees-cache-size <number>
1515 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1516 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1517 By default, this cache is disabled.
1518
1519 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001520 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1521
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001522wurfl-data-file <file path>
1523 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1524 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1525
1526 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1527 with USE_WURFL=1.
1528
1529wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1530 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1531 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1532 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1533
1534 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1535
1536 Valid WURFL properties are:
1537 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1538
1539 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1540 device.
1541
1542 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1543 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1544
1545 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1546 particular web request.
1547
1548 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1549 used Libwurfl API version.
1550
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001551 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1552 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1553
1554 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1555 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1556
1557 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1558
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001559 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1560 with USE_WURFL=1.
1561
1562wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1563 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1564 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1565
1566 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1567 with USE_WURFL=1.
1568
1569wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1570 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1571 thus before the chroot.
1572
1573 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1574 with USE_WURFL=1.
1575
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001576wurfl-cache-size <size>
1577 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
1578 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001579 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001580 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001581
1582 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1583 with USE_WURFL=1.
1584
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001585strict-limits
1586 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. Haproxy is tries to set
1587 the best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it
1588 will emit a warning. Use this option if you want an explicit failure of
1589 haproxy when those limits fail. This option is disabled by default. If it has
1590 been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no"
1591 keyword.
1592
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015933.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001594-----------------------
1595
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01001596busy-polling
1597 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
1598 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
1599 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
1600 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
1601 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
1602 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
1603 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
1604 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
1605 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
1606 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
1607 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
1608 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
1609 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
1610 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
1611 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
1612 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
1613 "poll" pollers.
1614
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01001615 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
1616 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
1617 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
1618
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001619max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1620 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1621 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1622 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1623 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1624 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1625 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1626 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1627 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1628
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001629maxconn <number>
1630 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1631 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1632 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001633 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1634 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1635 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1636 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01001637 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
1638 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
1639 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
1640 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
1641 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
1642 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001643
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001644maxconnrate <number>
1645 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1646 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1647 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1648 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1649 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1650 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1651 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1652 fairness.
1653
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001654maxcomprate <number>
1655 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001656 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001657 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1658 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1659 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001660 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001661 default value.
1662
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001663maxcompcpuusage <number>
1664 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1665 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1666 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1667 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1668 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1669 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1670 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1671 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1672
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001673maxpipes <number>
1674 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1675 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1676 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1677 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1678 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1679 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1680
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001681maxsessrate <number>
1682 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1683 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1684 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1685 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1686 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1687 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1688 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1689 fairness.
1690
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001691maxsslconn <number>
1692 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1693 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1694 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1695 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1696 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1697 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1698 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001699 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1700 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1701 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1702 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1703 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1704 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1705 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001706
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001707maxsslrate <number>
1708 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1709 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1710 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1711 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1712 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1713 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1714 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1715 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1716 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1717 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1718
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001719maxzlibmem <number>
1720 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1721 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1722 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001723 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1724 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1725 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1726
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001727noepoll
1728 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1729 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001730 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001731
1732nokqueue
1733 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1734 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1735 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1736
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001737noevports
1738 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
1739 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
1740 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
1741 also "nopoll".
1742
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001743nopoll
1744 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1745 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001746 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001747 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
1748 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001749
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001750nosplice
1751 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001752 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001753 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001754 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001755 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1756 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1757 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1758 "option splice-response".
1759
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001760nogetaddrinfo
1761 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1762 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1763
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001764noreuseport
1765 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1766 command line argument "-dR".
1767
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001768profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
1769 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
1770 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
1771 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
1772 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001773 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02001774 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
1775 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
1776 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
1777 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
1778
1779 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
1780 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
1781 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
1782 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
1783 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001784 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
1785 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
1786 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
1787 CLI.
1788
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001789spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001790 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1791 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1792 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1793 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1794 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1795 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001796
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001797ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001798 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001799 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001800 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1801 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1802 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1803 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1804 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001805 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1806 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001807 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1808 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1809 openssl configuration file uses:
1810 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1811
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001812ssl-mode-async
1813 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001814 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001815 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
1816 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
1817 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001818 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00001819 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001820
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001821tune.buffers.limit <number>
1822 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1823 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1824 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1825 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1826 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001827 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001828 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1829 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1830 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1831 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1832 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1833 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1834 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1835 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1836 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1837
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001838tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1839 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1840 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1841 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1842 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1843
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001844tune.bufsize <number>
1845 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1846 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1847 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1848 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1849 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1850 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1851 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01001852 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
1853 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
1854 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001855 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01001856 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
1857 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
1858 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001859
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001860tune.chksize <number>
1861 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1862 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1863 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1864 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1865 checks whenever possible.
1866
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001867tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1868 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1869 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1870 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1871 this value. The default value is 1.
1872
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01001873tune.fail-alloc
1874 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
1875 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
1876 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
1877 gracefully.
1878
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02001879tune.fd.edge-triggered { on | off } [ EXPERIMENTAL ]
1880 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the edge-triggered polling mode for FDs
1881 that support it. This is currently only support with epoll. It may noticeably
1882 reduce the number of epoll_ctl() calls and slightly improve performance in
1883 certain scenarios. This is still experimental, it may result in frozen
1884 connections if bugs are still present, and is disabled by default.
1885
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001886tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
1887 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
1888 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
1889 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
1890 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
1891 change it.
1892
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001893tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
1894 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001895 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
1896 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001897 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
1898 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
1899 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
1900 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
1901 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
1902
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001903tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
1904 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
1905 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
1906 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
1907 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
1908 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
1909 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
1910 recommended not to change this value.
1911
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01001912tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
1913 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
1914 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
1915 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
1916 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
1917 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
1918 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
1919 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
1920
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001921tune.http.cookielen <number>
1922 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1923 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1924 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1925 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1926 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1927 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1928 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1929 to change this value.
1930
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001931tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001932 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
1933 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001934 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001935 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001936 configuration directives too.
1937 The default value is 1024.
1938
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001939tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1940 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1941 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1942 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1943 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1944 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1945 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02001946 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
1947 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
1948 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001949
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001950tune.idletimer <timeout>
1951 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1952 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1953 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1954 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1955 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1956 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001957 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001958 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001959 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1960
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01001961tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
1962 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
1963 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
1964 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
1965 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
1966 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
1967 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
1968 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
1969 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
1970 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
1971
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001972tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1973 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001974 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001975 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1976 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001977 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001978 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1979 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1980
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001981tune.lua.maxmem
1982 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1983 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1984 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1985 memory.
1986
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001987tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1988 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001989 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1990 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001991 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001992
1993tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1994 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1995 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1996 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1997 check servers.
1998
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001999tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
2000 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
2001 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2002 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002003 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002004
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002005tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01002006 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
2007 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
2008 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
2009 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
2010 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
2011 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
2012 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
2013 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
2014 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
2015 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002016
2017tune.maxpollevents <number>
2018 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
2019 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
2020 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
2021 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
2022 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
2023
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002024tune.maxrewrite <number>
2025 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
2026 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
2027 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
2028 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
2029 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
2030 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
2031 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
2032 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
2033 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
2034 bufsize.
2035
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002036tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
2037 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
2038 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
2039 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
2040 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
2041 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
2042 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
2043 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
2044 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
2045 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02002046 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
2047 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002048 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
2049 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
2050 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
2051 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
2052 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
2053 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
2054 setting this parameter to 0.
2055
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02002056tune.pipesize <number>
2057 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
2058 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
2059 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
2060 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
2061 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
2062 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
2063
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002064tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
2065 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2066 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2067 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
2068 default is 20.
2069
2070tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
2071 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2072 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2073 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
2074 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
2075 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
2076 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002077 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002078
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002079tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
2080tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
2081 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
2082 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2083 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002084 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002085 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002086 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2087 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2088
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002089tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002090 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002091 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
2092 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
2093 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
2094 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
2095
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002096tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002097 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002098 tasks. The default value is 200. Increasing it may incur latency when
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002099 dealing with I/Os, making it too small can incur extra overhead. When
2100 experimenting with much larger values, it may be useful to also enable
2101 tune.sched.low-latency to limit the maximum latency to the lowest possible.
2102
2103tune.sched.low-latency { on | off }
2104 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the low-latency task scheduler. By default
2105 haproxy processes tasks from several classes one class at a time as this is
2106 the most efficient. But when running with large values of tune.runqueue-depth
2107 this can have a measurable effect on request or connection latency. When this
2108 low-latency setting is enabled, tasks of lower priority classes will always
2109 be executed before other ones if they exist. This will permit to lower the
2110 maximum latency experienced by new requests or connections in the middle of
2111 massive traffic, at the expense of a higher impact on this large traffic.
2112 For regular usage it is better to leave this off. The default value is off.
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002113
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002114tune.sndbuf.client <number>
2115tune.sndbuf.server <number>
2116 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
2117 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2118 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002119 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002120 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002121 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2122 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2123 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
2124 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
2125 notifying haproxy again.
2126
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002127tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002128 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
2129 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
2130 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002131 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002132 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002133 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002134 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
2135 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
2136 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01002137 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
2138 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002139
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002140tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02002141 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002142 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
2143 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
2144 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
2145 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
2146 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
2147
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002148tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
2149 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002150 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002151 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
2152 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
2153 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
2154 being used for too long.
2155
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002156tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
2157 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
2158 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
2159 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
2160 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
2161 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
2162 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
2163 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
2164 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
2165 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
2166 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002167 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002168 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002169
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002170tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
2171 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
2172 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
2173 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
2174 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
Willy Tarreau3ba77d22020-05-08 09:31:18 +02002175 this maximum value. Default value if 2048. Only 1024 or higher values are
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002176 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
2177 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002178 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
2179 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002180
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002181tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2182 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2183 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2184 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2185 1000 entries.
2186
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01002187tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
2188 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
2189 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
2190 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
2191
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002192tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002193tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002194tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2195tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2196tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002197 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2198 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2199 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2200 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2201 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2202 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2203 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2204 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002205
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002206 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2207 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2208 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2209 all available space is consumed.
2210 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2211 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2212 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002213
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002214tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2215 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002216 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002217 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002218 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002219 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2220
2221tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2222 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2223 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002224 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2225 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002226
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022273.3. Debugging
2228--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002229
Willy Tarreau1b857852020-02-25 11:27:22 +01002230debug (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002231 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
2232 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
2233 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
2234 system startup.
2235
2236quiet
2237 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2238 line argument "-q".
2239
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002240zero-warning
2241 When this option is set, haproxy will refuse to start if any warning was
2242 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
2243 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
2244 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
2245 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
2246 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
2247
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002248
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010022493.4. Userlists
2250--------------
2251It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2252http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2253it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2254
2255userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002256 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002257 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2258
2259group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002260 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002261 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2262 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2263
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002264user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2265 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002266 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2267 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002268 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2269 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2270 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2271 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002272
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002273 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2274 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2275 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2276 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2277 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2278 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2279 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
2280 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
2281 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002282
2283 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002284 userlist L1
2285 group G1 users tiger,scott
2286 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002287
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002288 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2289 user scott insecure-password elgato
2290 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002291
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002292 userlist L2
2293 group G1
2294 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002295
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002296 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2297 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2298 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002299
2300 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002301
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002302
23033.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002304----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002305It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
2306several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
2307instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2308values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2309automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2310In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2311using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2312tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2313reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2314Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2315that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2316each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002317
2318peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002319 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002320 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2321
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002322bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2323 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2324 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2325
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002326disabled
2327 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2328 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2329 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2330
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002331default-bind [param*]
2332 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2333
2334default-server [param*]
2335 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2336
2337 Arguments:
2338 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2339 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2340 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2341 details.
2342
2343
2344 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2345
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002346enable
2347 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2348
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01002349log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
2350 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
2351 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
2352 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
2353 more details.
2354
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002355peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002356 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2357 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002358 using "-L" command line option or "localpeer" global configuration setting),
2359 haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer connection on <ip>:<port>.
2360 Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to in order to join the
2361 remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to identify and
2362 validate the remote peer on the server side.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002363
2364 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2365 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2366
2367 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002368 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument or the "localpeer"
2369 global configuration setting to change the local peer name. This makes it
2370 easier to maintain coherent configuration files across all peers.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002371
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002372 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2373 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002374
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002375 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2376 "server" keyword explanation below).
2377
2378server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002379 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002380 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2381 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2382 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2383 of this "peers" section).
2384 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2385
2386
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002387 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002388 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002389 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002390 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2391 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2392 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002393
2394 backend mybackend
2395 mode tcp
2396 balance roundrobin
2397 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2398 stick on src
2399
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002400 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2401 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002402
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002403 Example:
2404 peers mypeers
2405 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2406 default-server ssl verify none
2407 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2408 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002409
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002410
2411table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
2412 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
2413
2414 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
2415 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002416 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002417 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
2418 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
2419 "stick-table" keyword).
2420
2421 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
2422 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
2423 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
2424 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
2425 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
2426 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
2427 of the stick-table name as follows:
2428
2429 peers mypeers
2430 peer A ...
2431 peer B ...
2432 table t1 ...
2433
2434 frontend fe1
2435 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
2436
2437 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
2438 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
2439
2440 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
2441 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
2442 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
2443 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
2444 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
2445 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
2446 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
2447
2448 peers mypeers
2449 peer A ...
2450 peer B ...
2451 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
2452
2453 backend t1
2454 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
2455
2456 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
2457 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
2458 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
2459
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090024603.6. Mailers
2461------------
2462It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2463If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2464in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2465
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002466mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002467 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2468 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2469
2470mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2471 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2472
2473 Example:
2474 mailers mymailers
2475 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2476 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2477
2478 backend mybackend
2479 mode tcp
2480 balance roundrobin
2481
2482 email-alert mailers mymailers
2483 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2484 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2485
2486 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2487 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2488
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002489timeout mail <time>
2490 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2491 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2492 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2493 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2494
2495 Example:
2496 mailers mymailers
2497 timeout mail 20s
2498 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002499
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020025003.7. Programs
2501-------------
2502In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
2503master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
2504managed the same way as the workers.
2505
2506During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
2507sequence as a worker:
2508
2509 - the master is re-executed
2510 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
2511 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
2512 instance of the program
2513
2514During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
2515
2516program <name>
2517 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
2518 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
2519 the management guide).
2520
2521command <command> [arguments*]
2522 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
2523 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
2524 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
2525 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
2526
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08002527user <user name>
2528 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2529 See also "group".
2530
2531group <group name>
2532 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
2533 See also "user".
2534
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02002535option start-on-reload
2536no option start-on-reload
2537 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
2538 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
2539 program section.
2540
2541
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010025423.8. HTTP-errors
2543----------------
2544
2545It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
2546imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
2547several places and can be fully or partially imported.
2548
2549http-errors <name>
2550 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
2551 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
2552
2553errorfile <code> <file>
2554 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
2555
2556 Arguments :
2557 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02002558 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
2559 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01002560
2561 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
2562 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
2563 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
2564 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
2565 before any chroot is performed.
2566
2567 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
2568
2569 Example:
2570 http-errors website-1
2571 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
2572 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
2573 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2574
2575 http-errors website-2
2576 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
2577 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
2578 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
2579
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +020025803.9. Rings
2581----------
2582
2583It is possible to globally declare ring-buffers, to be used as target for log
2584servers or traces.
2585
2586ring <ringname>
2587 Creates a new ring-buffer with name <ringname>.
2588
2589description <text>
2590 The descritpition is an optional description string of the ring. It will
2591 appear on CLI. By default, <name> is reused to fill this field.
2592
2593format <format>
2594 Format used to store events into the ring buffer.
2595
2596 Arguments:
2597 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
2598 one of the following :
2599
2600 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
2601 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
2602 designed to be used with a local log server.
2603
2604 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
2605 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
2606 used in containers or during development, where the severity
2607 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr). This
2608 is the default.
2609
2610 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
2611 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
2612
2613 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
2614 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
2615
2616 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
2617 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
2618 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
2619 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
2620 logger consumes.
2621
2622 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
2623 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
2624 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
2625 used with a local log server.
2626
2627maxlen <length>
2628 The maximum length of an event message stored into the ring,
2629 including formatted header. If an event message is longer than
2630 <length>, it will be truncated to this length.
2631
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02002632server <name> <address> [param*]
2633 Used to configure a syslog tcp server to forward messages from ring buffer.
2634 This supports for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph. Some of
2635 these parameters are irrelevant for "ring" sections. Important point: there
2636 is little reason to add more than one server to a ring, because all servers
2637 will receive the exact same copy of the ring contents, and as such the ring
2638 will progress at the speed of the slowest server. If one server does not
2639 respond, it will prevent old messages from being purged and may block new
2640 messages from being inserted into the ring. The proper way to send messages
2641 to multiple servers is to use one distinct ring per log server, not to
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02002642 attach multiple servers to the same ring. Note that specific server directive
2643 "log-proto" is used to set the protocol used to send messages.
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02002644
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002645size <size>
2646 This is the optional size in bytes for the ring-buffer. Default value is
2647 set to BUFSIZE.
2648
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02002649timeout connect <timeout>
2650 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2651
2652 Arguments :
2653 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
2654 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2655 as explained at the top of this document.
2656
2657timeout server <timeout>
2658 Set the maximum time for pending data staying into output buffer.
2659
2660 Arguments :
2661 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
2662 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2663 as explained at the top of this document.
2664
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002665 Example:
2666 global
2667 log ring@myring local7
2668
2669 ring myring
2670 description "My local buffer"
2671 format rfc3164
2672 maxlen 1200
2673 size 32764
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02002674 timeout connect 5s
2675 timeout server 10s
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02002676 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:6514 log-proto octet-count
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02002677
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01002678
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026794. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002680----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002681
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002682Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02002683 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002684 - frontend <name>
2685 - backend <name>
2686 - listen <name>
2687
2688A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
2689its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
2690section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002691section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002692
2693A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
2694connections.
2695
2696A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
2697to forward incoming connections.
2698
2699A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
2700parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
2701
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002702All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
2703'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
2704case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
2705
2706Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
2707logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
2708proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
2709However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
2710name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
2711
2712Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
2713and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002714bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002715protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
2716modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
2717arbitrary criteria.
2718
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002719In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
2720a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01002721the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002722
2723 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
2724 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
2725 between responses and new requests.
2726
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002727 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
2728 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
2729 client-facing connection remains open.
2730
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002731 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
2732 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002733
2734The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
2735frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
2736following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002737weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002738
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002739 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002740
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002741 | KAL | SCL | CLO
2742 ----+-----+-----+----
2743 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
2744 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02002745 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
2746 ----+-----+-----+----
2747 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002748
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002749
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01002750
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020027514.1. Proxy keywords matrix
2752--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002753
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002754The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
2755limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
2756they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
2757limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002758marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002759option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02002760and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
2761with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
2762specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002763
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002764
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002765 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
2766------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2767acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002768backlog X X X -
2769balance X - X X
2770bind - X X -
2771bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002772capture cookie - X X -
2773capture request header - X X -
2774capture response header - X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002775compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002776cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002777declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002778default-server X - X X
2779default_backend X X X -
2780description - X X X
2781disabled X X X X
2782dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002783email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09002784email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002785email-alert mailers X X X X
2786email-alert myhostname X X X X
2787email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002788enabled X X X X
2789errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01002790errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002791errorloc X X X X
2792errorloc302 X X X X
2793-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2794errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002795force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002796filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002797fullconn X - X X
2798grace X X X X
2799hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01002800http-after-response - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02002801http-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02002802http-check connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002803http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02002804http-check expect X - X X
Peter Gervai8912ae62020-06-11 18:26:36 +02002805http-check send X - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02002806http-check send-state X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02002807http-check set-var X - X X
2808http-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02002809http-error X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002810http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02002811http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02002812http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02002813http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002814id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01002815ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002816load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02002817log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01002818log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02002819log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01002820log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02002821max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002822maxconn X X X -
2823mode X X X X
2824monitor fail - X X -
2825monitor-net X X X -
2826monitor-uri X X X -
2827option abortonclose (*) X - X X
2828option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
2829option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
2830option allbackups (*) X - X X
2831option checkcache (*) X - X X
2832option clitcpka (*) X X X -
2833option contstats (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02002834option disable-h2-upgrade (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002835option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
2836option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002837-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2838option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02002839option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
2840option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02002841option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02002842option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01002843option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02002844option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02002845option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002846option http-server-close (*) X X X X
2847option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
2848option httpchk X - X X
2849option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01002850option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002851option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002852option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02002853option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002854option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002855option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
2856option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
2857option logasap (*) X X X -
2858option mysql-check X - X X
2859option nolinger (*) X X X X
2860option originalto X X X X
2861option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02002862option pgsql-check X - X X
2863option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002864option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02002865option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002866option smtpchk X - X X
2867option socket-stats (*) X X X -
2868option splice-auto (*) X X X X
2869option splice-request (*) X X X X
2870option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01002871option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002872option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
2873option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
2874-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01002875option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002876option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
2877option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
2878option tcpka X X X X
2879option tcplog X X X X
2880option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09002881external-check command X - X X
2882external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002883persist rdp-cookie X - X X
2884rate-limit sessions X X X -
2885redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002886-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002887retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02002888retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002889server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002890server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02002891server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002892source X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02002893stats admin - X X X
2894stats auth X X X X
2895stats enable X X X X
2896stats hide-version X X X X
2897stats http-request - X X X
2898stats realm X X X X
2899stats refresh X X X X
2900stats scope X X X X
2901stats show-desc X X X X
2902stats show-legends X X X X
2903stats show-node X X X X
2904stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002905-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2906stick match - - X X
2907stick on - - X X
2908stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02002909stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01002910stick-table - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02002911tcp-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02002912tcp-check connect X - X X
2913tcp-check expect X - X X
2914tcp-check send X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02002915tcp-check send-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02002916tcp-check send-binary X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02002917tcp-check send-binary-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02002918tcp-check set-var X - X X
2919tcp-check unset-var X - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02002920tcp-request connection - X X -
2921tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02002922tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02002923tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02002924tcp-response content - - X X
2925tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002926timeout check X - X X
2927timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002928timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002929timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002930timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
2931timeout http-request X X X X
2932timeout queue X - X X
2933timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002934timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002935timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02002936timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002937transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01002938unique-id-format X X X -
2939unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002940use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002941use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02002942use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002943------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2944 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002945
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002946
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020029474.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2948---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002949
2950This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2951
2952
2953acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2954 Declare or complete an access list.
2955 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2956 no | yes | yes | yes
2957 Example:
2958 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2959 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2960 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2961
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002962 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002963
2964
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002965backlog <conns>
2966 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2967 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2968 yes | yes | yes | no
2969 Arguments :
2970 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2971 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002972 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002973
2974 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2975 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2976 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2977 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2978 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2979 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2980 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2981 backlog parameter.
2982
2983 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2984 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2985 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2986
2987 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2988
2989
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002990balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002991balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002992 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2993 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2994 yes | no | yes | yes
2995 Arguments :
2996 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2997 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2998 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2999 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
3000
3001 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3002 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
3003 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
3004 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003005 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08003006 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003007 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
3008 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
3009 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
3010 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
3011 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
3012 it, so that you don't worry.
3013
3014 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3015 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
3016 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
3017 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
3018 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
3019 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
3020 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
3021 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003022
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003023 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
3024 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
3025 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
3026 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
3027 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
3028 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
3029 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
3030 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
3031
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003032 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003033 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003034 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
3035 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003036 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003037 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
3038 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
3039 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
3040 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
3041 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003042 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
3043 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
3044 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
3045 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
3046 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
3047 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003048
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003049 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
3050 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
3051 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
3052 address will always reach the same server as long as no
3053 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
3054 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
3055 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
3056 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003057 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003058 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003059 static by default, which means that changing a server's
3060 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
3061 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003062
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003063 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
3064 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
3065 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
3066 the running servers. The result designates which server will
3067 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
3068 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
3069 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
3070 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
3071 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
3072 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3073 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3074 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003075
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003076 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003077 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
3078 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
3079 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
3080 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
3081 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
3082 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
3083 URIs start with a leading "/".
3084
3085 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
3086 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
3087 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
3088 evaluation stops when either is reached.
3089
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003090 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003091 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
3092
3093 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003094 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
3095 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003096 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
3097 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
3098 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
3099 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003100 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003101 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
3102 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003103
3104 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
3105 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
3106 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
3107 server will receive the request.
3108
3109 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
3110 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
3111 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
3112 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
3113 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003114 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
3115 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
3116 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003117
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003118 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
3119 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
3120 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
3121 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
3122 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003123
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003124 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003125 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
3126 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
3127 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
3128
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003129 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3130 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3131 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3132
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003133 random
3134 random(<draws>)
3135 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003136 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
3137 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
3138 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
3139 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003140 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
3141 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
3142 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
3143 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
3144 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
3145 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
3146 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
3147 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
3148 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
3149 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
3150 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
3151 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
3152 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
3153 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
3154 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
3155 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
3156 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
3157 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
3158 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
3159 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003160
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003161 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02003162 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003163 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
3164 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
3165 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
3166 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
3167 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
3168 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003169 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003170 used instead.
3171
3172 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
3173 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
3174 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
3175 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
3176
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003177 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3178 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3179 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3180
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003181 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09003182
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003183 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003184 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
3185 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003186
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01003187 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
3188 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
3189 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003190
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003191 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003192 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003193 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
3194 NTLM relies on.
3195
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003196 Examples :
3197 balance roundrobin
3198 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003199 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003200 balance hdr(User-Agent)
3201 balance hdr(host)
3202 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003203
3204 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
3205 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
3206
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003207 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003208 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
3209 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
3210 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02003211 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003212
3213 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
3214 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
3215 defaults to 16 kB.
3216
3217 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
3218 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
3219
3220 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
3221 Round Robin.
3222
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00003223 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003224 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
3225 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
3226 actually appeared in the first chunk).
3227
3228 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
3229
3230 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003231 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003232 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
3233 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
3234 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003235
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003236 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003237
3238
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003239bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
3240bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003241 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
3242 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3243 no | yes | yes | no
3244 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003245 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
3246 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
3247 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
3248 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01003249 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003250 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
3251 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
3252 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
3253 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
3254 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
3255 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
3256 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02003257 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
3258 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
3259 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
3260 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
3261 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
3262 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
3263 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01003264 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
3265 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
3266 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02003267 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
3268 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
3269 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
3270 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003271 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
3272 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
3273 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003274
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003275 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
3276 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003277 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
3278 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
3279 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003280 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
3281 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
3282 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
3283 the range.
3284
3285 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
3286 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
3287 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
3288 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
3289 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
3290 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
3291 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003292 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003293 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003294
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003295 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003296 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003297 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
3298 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
3299 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
3300 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
3301 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
3302 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
3303
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003304 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
3305 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
3306 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
3307 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003308
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003309 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
3310 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
3311 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
3312 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
3313 in a frontend.
3314
3315 Example :
3316 listen http_proxy
3317 bind :80,:443
3318 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003319 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003320
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003321 listen http_https_proxy
3322 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02003323 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003324
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003325 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
3326 bind ipv6@:80
3327 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
3328 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
3329
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003330 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003331 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003332
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02003333 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
3334 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
3335 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
3336 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
3337 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
3338
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003339 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003340 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003341
3342
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003343bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003344 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
3345 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3346 yes | yes | yes | yes
3347 Arguments :
3348 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
3349 may be used to override a default value.
3350
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003351 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003352 option may be combined with other numbers.
3353
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003354 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003355 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
3356 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
3357 missing from all processes.
3358
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003359 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003360 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003361 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
3362 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
3363 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
3364 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
3365 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02003366 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003367
3368 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
3369 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
3370 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
3371 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
3372 and 'even' instances.
3373
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003374 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
3375 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
3376 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
3377 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003378
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003379 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
3380 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
3381
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02003382 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
3383 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
3384 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
3385
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003386 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
3387 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
3388
3389 Example :
3390 listen app_ip1
3391 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003392 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003393
3394 listen app_ip2
3395 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003396 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003397
3398 listen management
3399 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02003400 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003401
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01003402 listen management
3403 bind 10.0.0.4:80
3404 bind-process 1-4
3405
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02003406 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003407
3408
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003409capture cookie <name> len <length>
3410 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
3411 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3412 no | yes | yes | no
3413 Arguments :
3414 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
3415 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
3416 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
3417 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003418 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003419
3420 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
3421 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
3422 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
3423 right if it exceeds <length>.
3424
3425 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
3426 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
3427 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
3428 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
3429
3430 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
3431 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
3432 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
3433
3434 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
3435 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
3436 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01003437 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
3438 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
3439 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003440
3441 Example:
3442 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
3443
3444 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003445 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003446
3447
3448capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003449 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003450 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3451 no | yes | yes | no
3452 Arguments :
3453 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003454 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003455 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
3456 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3457 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3458
3459 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3460 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3461 it exceeds <length>.
3462
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003463 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003464 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
3465 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003466 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
3467 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
3468 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
3469 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003470 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003471 environments to find where the request came from.
3472
3473 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
3474 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
3475 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
3476 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003477
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003478 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
3479 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3480 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3481 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3482 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003483
3484 Example:
3485 capture request header Host len 15
3486 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01003487 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003488
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003489 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003490 about logging.
3491
3492
3493capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003494 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003495 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3496 no | yes | yes | no
3497 Arguments :
3498 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003499 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003500 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
3501 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
3502 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
3503
3504 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
3505 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
3506 it exceeds <length>.
3507
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01003508 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003509 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
3510 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
3511 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01003512 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
3513 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
3514 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
3515 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003516
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01003517 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
3518 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
3519 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
3520 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
3521 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003522
3523 Example:
3524 capture response header Content-length len 9
3525 capture response header Location len 15
3526
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003527 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003528 about logging.
3529
3530
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003531compression algo <algorithm> ...
3532compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003533compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003534 Enable HTTP compression.
3535 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3536 yes | yes | yes | yes
3537 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003538 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
3539 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
3540 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
3541
3542 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003543 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
3544 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
3545 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003546
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003547 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003548 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003549
3550 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
3551 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
3552 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
3553 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
3554 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003555 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003556
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01003557 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
3558 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
3559 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
3560 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
3561 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
3562 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
3563 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01003564 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003565
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04003566 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01003567 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003568 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
3569 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
3570 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
3571 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
3572 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02003573
3574 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
3575 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
3576 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
3577 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
3578 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04003579 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
3580 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
3581 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
3582 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
3583 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02003584 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
3585 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003586
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003587 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003588 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
3589 "Accept-Encoding" header
3590 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003591 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01003592 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
3593 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
3594 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
3595 "multipart"
3596 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
3597 header
3598 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
3599 and later
3600 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
3601 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01003602 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003603
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01003604 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01003605
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003606 Examples :
3607 compression algo gzip
3608 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003609
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003610
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02003611cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003612 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
3613 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01003614 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003615 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
3616 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3617 yes | no | yes | yes
3618 Arguments :
3619 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
3620 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
3621 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
3622 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
3623 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
3624 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003625 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003626 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
3627 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
3628
3629 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
3630 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
3631 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
3632 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
3633 headers is left to the application. The application can then
3634 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003635 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
3636 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003637 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003638 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
3639 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003640
3641 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003642 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003643
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003644 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003645 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003646 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003647 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003648 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
3649 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
3650 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
3651 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
3652 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
3653 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
3654 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003655
3656 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
3657 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
3658 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
3659 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
3660 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
3661 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
3662 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
3663 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
3664 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01003665 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003666 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
3667 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
3668 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003669
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02003670 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
3671 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
3672 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003673 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
3674 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
3675 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
3676 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02003677 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
3678 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
3679 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003680
3681 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
3682 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
3683 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
3684 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
3685 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
3686 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
3687 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
3688 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
3689 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
3690
3691 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
3692 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
3693 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
3694 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
3695 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
3696 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
3697 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
3698 persistence cookie in the cache.
3699 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
3700
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003701 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
3702 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
3703 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
3704 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
3705 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003706 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02003707 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
3708 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
3709 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
3710 they logout.
3711
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02003712 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
3713 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
3714 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
3715 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
3716
3717 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
3718 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
3719 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
3720 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
3721 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
3722 this attribute.
3723
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003724 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003725 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01003726 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
3727 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
3728 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
3729 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
3730 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
3731 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02003732
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003733 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
3734 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
3735 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
3736 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
3737 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
3738 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
3739 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
3740 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003741 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003742 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
3743 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
3744 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
3745 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
3746 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
3747 the site.
3748
3749 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
3750 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
3751 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
3752 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
3753 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
3754 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
3755 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
3756 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
3757 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
3758 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
3759 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
3760 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
3761 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003762 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003763 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
3764 redispatch after some absolute delay.
3765
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003766 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
3767 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
3768 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
3769 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
3770 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
3771 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
3772
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01003773 attr This option tells haproxy to add an extra attribute when a
3774 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
3775 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
3776 repeated.
3777
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003778 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
3779 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
3780 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
3781 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003782
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003783 Examples :
3784 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
3785 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
3786 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003787 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003788
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003789 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003790
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003791
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003792declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
3793 Declares a capture slot.
3794 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3795 no | yes | yes | no
3796 Arguments:
3797 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
3798
3799 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
3800 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
3801 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
3802 for use in the response.
3803
3804 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02003805 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003806 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
3807
3808
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003809default-server [param*]
3810 Change default options for a server in a backend
3811 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3812 yes | no | yes | yes
3813 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003814 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3815 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3816 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3817 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003818
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003819 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003820 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
3821
3822 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003823
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003824
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003825default_backend <backend>
3826 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
3827 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3828 yes | yes | yes | no
3829 Arguments :
3830 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
3831
3832 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
3833 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
3834 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
3835 will catch all undetermined requests.
3836
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003837 Example :
3838
3839 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
3840 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
3841 default_backend dynamic
3842
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02003843 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003844
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003845
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003846description <string>
3847 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3848 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3849 no | yes | yes | yes
3850 Arguments : string
3851
3852 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3853 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3854 it describes.
3855 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3856
3857
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003858disabled
3859 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3860 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3861 yes | yes | yes | yes
3862 Arguments : none
3863
3864 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3865 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3866 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3867 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3868 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3869 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3870 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3871
3872 See also : "enabled"
3873
3874
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003875dispatch <address>:<port>
3876 Set a default server address
3877 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3878 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003879 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003880
3881 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3882 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3883 during start-up.
3884
3885 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3886 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3887 possible with normal servers.
3888
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003889 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003890 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3891 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3892 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3893 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3894
3895 See also : "server"
3896
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003897
3898dynamic-cookie-key <string>
3899 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
3900 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3901 yes | no | yes | yes
3902 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
3903
3904 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003905 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003906 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
3907 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003908 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003909 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003910
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003911enabled
3912 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3913 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3914 yes | yes | yes | yes
3915 Arguments : none
3916
3917 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3918 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3919
3920 See also : "disabled"
3921
3922
3923errorfile <code> <file>
3924 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3925 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3926 yes | yes | yes | yes
3927 Arguments :
3928 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02003929 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02003930 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003931
3932 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003933 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003934 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003935 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3936 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003937
3938 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3939 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3940 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3941
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003942 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3943
Christopher Faulet70170672020-05-18 17:42:48 +02003944 The files are parsed when HAProxy starts and must be valid according to the
3945 HTTP specification. They should not exceed the configured buffer size
3946 (BUFSIZE), which generally is 16 kB, otherwise an internal error will be
3947 returned. It is also wise not to put any reference to local contents
3948 (e.g. images) in order to avoid loops between the client and HAProxy when all
3949 servers are down, causing an error to be returned instead of an
3950 image. Finally, The response cannot exceed (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite)
3951 so that "http-after-response" rules still have room to operate (see
3952 "tune.maxrewrite").
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003953
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003954 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3955 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3956 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003957 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003958 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3959
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02003960 See also : "http-error", "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003961
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003962 Example :
3963 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003964 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003965 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3966 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3967
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003968
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003969errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
3970 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
3971 section.
3972 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3973 yes | yes | yes | yes
3974 Arguments :
3975 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
3976
3977 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02003978 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 401,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02003979 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003980
3981 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
3982 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
3983 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
3984 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
3985 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
3986 ones. Fonctionnly, it is exactly the same than declaring all error files by
3987 hand using "errorfile" directives.
3988
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02003989 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" ,
3990 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003991
3992 Example :
3993 errorfiles generic
3994 errorfiles site-1 403 404
3995
3996
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003997errorloc <code> <url>
3998errorloc302 <code> <url>
3999 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4000 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4001 yes | yes | yes | yes
4002 Arguments :
4003 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004004 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02004005 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004006
4007 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4008 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4009 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4010 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004011 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004012
4013 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4014 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4015 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4016
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004017 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4018
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004019 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
4020 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
4021 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
4022 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004023 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004024 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
4025 request.
4026
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004027 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004028
4029
4030errorloc303 <code> <url>
4031 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4032 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4033 yes | yes | yes | yes
4034 Arguments :
4035 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004036 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02004037 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004038
4039 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4040 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4041 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4042 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004043 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004044
4045 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4046 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4047 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4048
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004049 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4050
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004051 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
4052 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
4053 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
4054 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004055 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004056
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004057 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004058
4059
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004060email-alert from <emailaddr>
4061 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004062 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004063 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4064 yes | yes | yes | yes
4065
4066 Arguments :
4067
4068 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
4069
4070 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4071 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4072
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004073 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02004074 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
4075 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004076
4077
4078email-alert level <level>
4079 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
4080 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
4081 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4082 yes | yes | yes | yes
4083
4084 Arguments :
4085
4086 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
4087 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4088 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
4089
4090 By default level is alert
4091
4092 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4093 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4094 for the proxy.
4095
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09004096 Alerts are sent when :
4097
4098 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
4099 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
4100 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
4101 is notice or lower
4102 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
4103 and a health check status update occurs
4104
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004105 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
4106 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004107 section 3.6 about mailers.
4108
4109
4110email-alert mailers <mailersect>
4111 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
4112 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4113 yes | yes | yes | yes
4114
4115 Arguments :
4116
4117 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
4118
4119 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
4120 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4121
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004122 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
4123 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004124
4125
4126email-alert myhostname <hostname>
4127 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
4128 mailers.
4129 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4130 yes | yes | yes | yes
4131
4132 Arguments :
4133
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01004134 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004135
4136 By default the systems hostname is used.
4137
4138 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4139 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4140 for the proxy.
4141
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004142 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
4143 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004144
4145
4146email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004147 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004148 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
4149 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4150 yes | yes | yes | yes
4151
4152 Arguments :
4153
4154 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
4155
4156 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4157 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4158
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004159 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004160 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
4161
4162
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004163force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4164 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
4165 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01004166 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004167
4168 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
4169 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
4170 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
4171 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
4172 marked down for maintenance operations.
4173
4174 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4175 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
4176 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
4177 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
4178 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
4179 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
4180 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
4181 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
4182 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
4183
4184 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4185 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
4186 is used.
4187
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004188 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02004189 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004190
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004191
4192filter <name> [param*]
4193 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
4194 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4195 no | yes | yes | yes
4196 Arguments :
4197 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
4198 referenced in section 9.
4199
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004200 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004201 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004202 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
4203 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004204
4205 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
4206 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
4207
4208 Example:
4209 listen
4210 bind *:80
4211
4212 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
4213 filter compression
4214 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
4215
4216 compression algo gzip
4217 compression offload
4218
4219 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
4220
4221 See also : section 9.
4222
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004223
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004224fullconn <conns>
4225 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
4226 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4227 yes | no | yes | yes
4228 Arguments :
4229 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
4230 servers use the maximal number of connections.
4231
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004232 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004233 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004234 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004235 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
4236 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
4237 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
4238 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
4239 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004240 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004241
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004242 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
4243 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01004244 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
4245 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
4246 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004247
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004248 Example :
4249 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
4250 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
4251 # connections.
4252 backend dynamic
4253 fullconn 10000
4254 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4255 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4256
4257 See also : "maxconn", "server"
4258
4259
4260grace <time>
4261 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
4262 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01004263 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004264 Arguments :
4265 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
4266 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
4267 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
4268
4269 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
4270 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004271 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004272 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
4273
4274 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
4275 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
4276 simplify it.
4277
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004278
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004279hash-balance-factor <factor>
4280 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
4281 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4282 yes | no | no | yes
4283 Arguments :
4284 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
4285 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01004286 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004287
4288 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
4289 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
4290 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
4291 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
4292 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
4293 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
4294 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
4295
4296 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
4297 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
4298 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
4299 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
4300 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
4301
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004302 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
4303 consistent hashing mechanism.
4304
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004305 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
4306
4307
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004308hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004309 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
4310 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4311 yes | no | yes | yes
4312 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004313 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
4314 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004315
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004316 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
4317 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
4318 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
4319 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
4320 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
4321 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
4322 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
4323 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
4324 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
4325 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01004326
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004327 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
4328 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
4329 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
4330 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
4331 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
4332 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
4333 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
4334 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
4335 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
4336 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
4337 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
4338 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
4339 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004340 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
4341 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004342
4343 <function> is the hash function to be used :
4344
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004345 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004346 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
4347 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
4348 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004349 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
4350 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
4351 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004352
4353 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
4354 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004355 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
4356 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
4357 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
4358 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
4359
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01004360 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
4361 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
4362 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
4363 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
4364 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
4365 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
4366 parameter.
4367
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01004368 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
4369 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
4370 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
4371 used on strings.
4372
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004373 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
4374
4375 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
4376 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
4377 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
4378 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
4379 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
4380 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
4381 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
4382 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
4383 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
4384 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
4385 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
4386 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004387
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004388 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
4389 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
4390 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004391
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004392 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004393
4394
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004395http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4396 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
4397 ones).
4398
4399 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4400 no | yes | yes | yes
4401
4402 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
4403 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
4404 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4405 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4406 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4407 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4408
4409 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
4410 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
4411 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
4412
4413 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
4414 below.
4415
4416 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
4417 instance.
4418
4419 Example:
4420 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
4421 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
4422 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
4423
4424http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4425
4426 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
4427 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
4428 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
4429 example, or to pass some internal information.
4430 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4431 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
4432 the resulting header from a previous rule.
4433
4434http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4435
4436 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
4437 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated.
4438
4439http-after-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4440
4441 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
4442
4443http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4444 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4445
4446 This works like "http-response replace-header".
4447
4448 Example:
4449 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
4450
4451 # applied to:
4452 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4453
4454 # outputs:
4455 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4456
4457 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
4458
4459http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
4460 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4461
4462 This works like "http-response replace-value".
4463
4464 Example:
4465 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
4466
4467 # applied to:
4468 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
4469
4470 # outputs:
4471 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
4472
4473http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4474
4475 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
4476 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
4477 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
4478
4479http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
4480 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4481
4482 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
4483 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
4484 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
4485 fallback.
4486
4487 Example:
4488 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
4489 http-response set-status 431
4490 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
4491 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down"
4492
4493http-after-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4494
4495 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4496 inline.
4497
4498 Arguments:
4499 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4500 scope. The scopes allowed are:
4501 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
4502 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4503 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
4504 (request and response)
4505 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
4506 processing
4507 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4508 processing
4509 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4510 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
4511 and '_'.
4512
4513 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4514 followed by some converters.
4515
4516 Example:
4517 http-after-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
4518
4519http-after-response strict-mode { on | off }
4520
4521 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
4522 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
4523 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
4524 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
4525 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05004526 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004527 processing.
4528
4529 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
4530 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
4531 the bacnkend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
4532 rules evaluation.
4533
4534http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
4535
4536 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-after-response set-var" for
4537 details about <var-name>.
4538
4539 Example:
4540 http-after-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
4541
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004542
4543http-check comment <string>
4544 Defines a comment for the following the http-check rule, reported in logs if
4545 it fails.
4546 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4547 yes | no | yes | yes
4548
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004549 Arguments :
4550 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following http-check
4551 rule fails.
4552
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004553 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
4554 user-friendly error reporting.
4555
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004556 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check conncet", "http-check send" and
4557 "http-check expect".
4558
4559
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004560http-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy]
4561 [via-socks4] [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02004562 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004563 Opens a new connection to perform an HTTP health check
4564 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4565 yes | no | yes | yes
4566
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004567 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004568 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
4569
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004570 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
4571 checks. The server options are used only if not redifined.
4572
4573 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
4574 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
4575 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
4576 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
4577
4578 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
4579
4580 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
4581
4582 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
4583
4584 ssl opens a ciphered connection
4585
4586 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
4587
4588 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
4589 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
4590 for instance: "h2,http/1.1". If it is not set, the server ALPN
4591 is used.
4592
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02004593 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
4594 It must be an HTTP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
4595 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
4596 haproxy -vv.
4597
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004598 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
4599
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004600 Just like tcp-check health checks, it is possible to configure the connection
4601 to use to perform HTTP health check. This directive should also be used to
4602 describe a scenario involving several request/response exchanges, possibly on
4603 different ports or with different servers.
4604
4605 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
4606 directive, then the first step of the http-check sequence must be to specify
4607 the port with a "http-check connect".
4608
4609 In an http-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
4610 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
4611 do.
4612
4613 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
4614 unset-var or comment rules.
4615
4616 Examples :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004617 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
4618 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
4619 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
4620 option httpchk
4621
4622 http-check connect
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02004623 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02004624 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004625 http-check connect port 443 ssl sni haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02004626 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02004627 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004628
4629 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
4630
4631 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send", "http-check expect"
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01004632
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004633
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004634http-check disable-on-404
4635 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
4636 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004637 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004638 Arguments : none
4639
4640 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
4641 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
4642 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
4643 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
4644 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
4645 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
4646 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
4647 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004648 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
4649 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
4650 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
4651
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004652 See also : "option httpchk" and "http-check expect".
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004653
4654
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004655http-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004656 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
4657 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
4658 [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004659 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004660 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02004661 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004662
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004663 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004664 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
4665
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004666 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
4667 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
4668 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
4669 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
4670 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
4671 incomplete. If an exact string is used, the minimum between the
4672 string length and this parameter is used. This parameter is
4673 ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule does not match,
4674 the check will wait for more data. If set to 0, the evaluation
4675 result is always conclusive.
4676
4677 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
4678 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
4679 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02004680 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
4681 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
4682 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, for
4683 example 404 with disable-on-404
4684 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
4685 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
4686 By default "L7OK" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004687
4688 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
4689 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02004690 "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are supported :
4691 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
4692 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
4693 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
4694 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
4695 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004696
4697 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
4698 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02004699 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
4700 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
4701 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
4702 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004703 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
4704
4705 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
4706 informational message reported in logs if the expect
4707 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
4708 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
4709
4710 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
4711 informational message reported in logs if an error
4712 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
4713 log-format string.
4714
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004715 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02004716 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus", "hdr",
4717 "fhdr", "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004718 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
4719 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
4720 details on the supported keywords.
4721
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02004722 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string, a regular
4723 expression or a more complex pattern with several arguments. If
4724 the string pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped with the
4725 usual backslash ('\').
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004726
4727 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
4728 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
4729 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
4730 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
4731 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
4732
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02004733 status <codes> : test the status codes found parsing <codes> string. it
4734 must be a comma-separated list of status codes or range
4735 codes. A health check response will be considered as
4736 valid if the response's status code matches any status
4737 code or is inside any range of the list. If the "status"
4738 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4739 considered invalid if the status code matches.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004740
4741 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004742 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004743 response's status code matches the expression. If the
4744 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4745 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
4746 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
4747
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02004748 hdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
4749 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02004750 test the specified header pattern on the HTTP response
4751 headers. The name pattern is mandatory but the value
4752 pattern is optional. If not specified, only the header
4753 presence is verified. <meth> is the matching method,
4754 applied on the header name or the header value. Supported
4755 matching methods are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix
4756 match), "end" (suffix match), "sub" (substring match) or
4757 "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02004758 method is used. If the "name-lf" parameter is used,
4759 <name> is evaluated as a log-format string. If "value-lf"
4760 parameter is used, <value> is evaluated as a log-format
4761 string. These parameters cannot be used with the regex
4762 matching method. Finally, the header value is considered
4763 as comma-separated list. Note that matchings are case
4764 insensitive on the header names.
4765
4766 fhdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
4767 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
4768 test the specified full header pattern on the HTTP
4769 response headers. It does exactly the same than "hdr"
4770 keyword, except the full header value is tested, commas
4771 are not considered as delimiters.
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02004772
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004773 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004774 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004775 response's body contains this exact string. If the
4776 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
4777 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
4778 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
4779 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004780 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004781 trace).
4782
4783 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004784 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004785 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
4786 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4787 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
4788 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
4789 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004790 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004791
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +02004792 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the HTTP response body.
4793 A health check response will be considered valid if the
4794 response's body contains the string resulting of the
4795 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
4796 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
4797 considered invalid if the body contains the string.
4798
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004799 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
4800 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
4801 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
4802 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
4803 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
4804 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
4805 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
4806 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
4807
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004808 In an http-check ruleset, the last expect rule may be implicit. If no expect
4809 rule is specified after the last "http-check send", an implicit expect rule
4810 is defined to match on 2xx or 3xx status codes. It means this rule is also
4811 defined if there is no "http-check" rule at all, when only "option httpchk"
4812 is set.
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01004813
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004814 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
4815 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
4816
4817 Examples :
4818 # only accept status 200 as valid
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02004819 http-check expect status 200,201,300-310
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004820
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02004821 # be sure a sessid coookie is set
4822 http-check expect header name "set-cookie" value -m beg "sessid="
4823
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004824 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004825 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004826
4827 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01004828 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01004829
4830 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03004831 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004832
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004833 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check disable-on-404"
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004834 and "http-check send".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004835
4836
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02004837http-check send [meth <method>] [{ uri <uri> | uri-lf <fmt> }>] [ver <version>]
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02004838 [hdr <name> <fmt>]* [{ body <string> | body-lf <fmt> }]
4839 [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02004840 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
4841 health checks.
4842 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4843 yes | no | yes | yes
4844 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004845 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
4846
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004847 meth <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not
4848 set, the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires
4849 low server processing and is easy to filter out from the
4850 logs. Any method may be used, though it is not recommended
4851 to invent non-standard ones.
4852
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02004853 uri <uri> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
4854 to the string <uri>. It defaults to "/" which is accessible
4855 by default on almost any server, but may be changed to any
4856 other URI. Query strings are permitted.
4857
4858 uri-lf <fmt> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
4859 using the log-format string <fmt>. It defaults to "/" which
4860 is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
4861 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02004862
Christopher Faulet907701b2020-04-28 09:37:00 +02004863 ver <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004864 "HTTP/1.0" but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP
4865 1.0, so turningit to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that
4866 the Host field is mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "hdr" argument
4867 to add it.
4868
4869 hdr <name> <fmt> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
4870 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt>, which follows
4871 to the log-format rules.
4872
4873 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent during
4874 HTTP health checks. If defined, the "Content-Length" header
4875 is thus automatically added to the request.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02004876
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02004877 body-lf <fmt> add the body defined by the log-format string <fmt> to the
4878 request sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
4879 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added to the
4880 request.
4881
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02004882 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
4883 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
4884 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02004885 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. Thus, this header or
4886 "Transfer-encoding" header should not be present in the request provided by
4887 "http-check send". If so, it will be ignored. The old trick consisting to add
4888 headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02004889 deprecated. Note also the "Connection: close" header is still added if a
4890 "http-check expect" direcive is defined independently of this directive, just
4891 like the state header if the directive "http-check send-state" is defined.
4892
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004893 Also "http-check send" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
4894 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02004895 header should not be present in the request provided by "http-check send". If
4896 so, it will be ignored.
4897
4898 Note that the Host header and the request authority, when both defined, are
4899 automatically synchronized. It means when the HTTP request is sent, when a
4900 Host is inserted in the request, the request authority is accordingly
4901 updated. Thus, don't be surprised if the Host header value overwrites the
4902 configured request authority.
4903
4904 Note also for now, no Host header is automatically added in HTTP/1.1 or above
4905 requests. You should add it explicitly.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004906
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004907 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect".
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02004908
4909
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004910http-check send-state
4911 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
4912 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4913 yes | no | yes | yes
4914 Arguments : none
4915
4916 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
4917 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
4918 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
4919 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
4920 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
4921
4922 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
4923 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
4924 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
4925 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
4926 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08004927 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
4928 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
4929 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4930
4931 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
4932 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
4933 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
4934
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004935 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
4936 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
4937 checked in multiple backends.
4938
4939 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
4940 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
4941
4942 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
4943 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
4944 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
4945 one fails.
4946
4947 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
4948 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
4949 connections on all servers of the same backend.
4950
4951 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
4952 server's queue.
4953
4954 Example of a header received by the application server :
4955 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
4956 scur=13/22; qcur=0
4957
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004958 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404" and
4959 "http-check send".
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004960
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004961
4962http-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004963 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004964 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4965 yes | no | yes | yes
4966
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004967 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004968 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4969 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
4970 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
4971 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
4972 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
4973 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4974 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
4975 and '-'.
4976
4977 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
4978
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004979 Examples :
4980 http-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004981
4982
4983http-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004984 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004985 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4986 yes | no | yes | yes
4987
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004988 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004989 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
4990 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
4991 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
4992 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
4993 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
4994 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
4995 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
4996 and '-'.
4997
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02004998 Examples :
4999 http-check unset-var(check.port)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005000
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005001
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005002http-error status <code> [content-type <type>]
5003 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5004 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5005 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5006 Defines a custom error message to use instead of errors generated by HAProxy.
5007 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5008 yes | yes | yes | yes
5009 Arguments :
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005010 status <code> is the HTTP status code. It must be specified.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005011 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005012 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425,
5013 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005014
5015 content-type <type> is the response content type, for instance
5016 "text/plain". This parameter is ignored and should be
5017 omitted when an errorfile is configured or when the
5018 payload is empty. Otherwise, it must be defined.
5019
5020 default-errorfiles Reset the previously defined error message for current
5021 proxy for the status <code>. If used on a backend, the
5022 frontend error message is used, if defined. If used on
5023 a frontend, the default error message is used.
5024
5025 errorfile <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response.
5026 It is recommended to follow the common practice of
5027 appending ".http" to the filename so that people do
5028 not confuse the response with HTML error pages, and to
5029 use absolute paths, since files are read before any
5030 chroot is performed.
5031
5032 errorfiles <name> designates the http-errors section to use to import
5033 the error message with the status code <code>. If no
5034 such message is found, the proxy's error messages are
5035 considered.
5036
5037 file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5038 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5039 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5040 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5041 considered as a raw string.
5042
5043 string <str> specifies the raw string to use as response payload.
5044 The content-type must always be set as argument to
5045 "content-type".
5046
5047 lf-file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5048 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5049 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5050 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5051 evaluated as a log-format string.
5052
5053 lf-string <str> specifies the log-format string to use as response
5054 payload. The content-type must always be set as
5055 argument to "content-type".
5056
5057 hdr <name> <fmt> adds to the response the HTTP header field whose name
5058 is specified in <name> and whose value is defined by
5059 <fmt>, which follows to the log-format rules.
5060 This parameter is ignored if an errorfile is used.
5061
5062 This directive may be used instead of "errorfile", to define a custom error
5063 message. As "errorfile" directive, it is used for errors detected and
5064 returned by HAProxy. If an errorfile is defined, it is parsed when HAProxy
5065 starts and must be valid according to the HTTP standards. The generated
5066 response must not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFFSIZE), otherwise an
5067 internal error will be returned. Finally, if you consider to use some
5068 http-after-response rules to rewrite these errors, the reserved buffer space
5069 should be available (see "tune.maxrewrite").
5070
5071 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
5072 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
5073 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running.
5074
5075 See also : "errorfile", "errorfiles", "errorloc", "errorloc302",
5076 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
5077
5078
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005079http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005080 Access control for Layer 7 requests
5081
5082 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5083 no | yes | yes | yes
5084
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005085 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5086 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5087 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5088 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5089 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005090
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005091 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5092 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005093
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005094 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005095
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005096 Example:
5097 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
5098 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
5099 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005100
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005101 http-request allow if nagios
5102 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
5103 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
5104 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01005105
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005106 Example:
5107 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
5108 acl add path /addacl
5109 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005110
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005111 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005112
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005113 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
5114 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02005115
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005116 Example:
5117 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
5118 acl setmap path /setmap
5119 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005120
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005121 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005122
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005123 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
5124 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005125
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005126 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5127 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005128
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005129http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005130
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005131 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5132 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5133 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5134 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
5135 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
5136 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5137 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5138 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005139
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005140http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005141
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005142 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
5143 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
5144 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
5145 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
5146 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
5147 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
5148 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
5149 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005150
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005151http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005152
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005153 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
5154 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005155
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005156
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005157http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005158
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005159 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
5160 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
5161 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
5162 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
5163 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005164
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005165 The corresponding proxy's error message is used. It may be customized using
5166 an "errorfile" or an "http-error" directive. For 401 responses, all
5167 occurrences of the WWW-Authenticate header are removed and replaced by a new
5168 one with a basic authentication challenge for realm "<realm>". For 407
5169 responses, the same is done on the Proxy-Authenticate header. If the error
5170 message must not be altered, consider to use "http-request return" rule
5171 instead.
5172
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005173 Example:
5174 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
5175 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005176
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02005177http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005178
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02005179 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005180
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005181http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
5182 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005183
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005184 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
5185 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
5186 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
5187 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
5188 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
5189 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
5190 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
5191 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
5192 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005193
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005194 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
5195 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
5196 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01005197 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
5198
5199 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
5200 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
5201 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
5202 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005203
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005204http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005205
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005206 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5207 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5208 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5209 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5210 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5211 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005212
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005213http-request del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02005214
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005215 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02005216
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005217http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02005218
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005219 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5220 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5221 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5222 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5223 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
5224 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02005225
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005226http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5227http-request deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
5228 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5229 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5230 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5231 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04005232
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005233 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request.
5234 By default an HTTP 403 error is returned. But the response may be customized
5235 using same syntax than "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005236 return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined,
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005237 or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
5238 "http-request deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
5239 "http-request deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005240 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005241 See also "http-request return".
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04005242
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02005243http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5244 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
5245 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
5246 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
5247
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01005248http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
5249
5250 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
5251 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
5252 pointed by <resolvers>.
5253 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
5254 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
5255 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
5256 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
5257 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
5258 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
5259 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
5260 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
5261 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
5262 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
5263 to 0.0.0.0.
5264
5265 Example:
5266 resolvers mydns
5267 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
5268 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
5269 timeout retry 1s
5270 hold valid 10s
5271 hold nx 3s
5272 hold other 3s
5273 hold obsolete 0s
5274 accepted_payload_size 8192
5275
5276 frontend fe
5277 bind 10.42.0.1:80
5278 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
5279 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
5280
5281 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
5282 # which mean DNS resolution error
5283 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
5284
5285 default_backend be
5286
5287 backend b_503
5288 # dummy backend used to return 503.
5289 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
5290 # 503 error page to end users
5291
5292 backend be
5293 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
5294 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
5295 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
5296 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
5297 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
5298
5299 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
5300 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
5301
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01005302http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5303
5304 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
5305 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
5306 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
5307 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01005308 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
5309 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01005310
5311 See RFC 8297 for more information.
5312
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005313http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005314
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005315 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
5316 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
5317 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
5318 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
5319 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005320
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005321http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005322
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005323 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
5324 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
5325 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
5326 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005327
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005328http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5329 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02005330
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005331 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005332 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
5333 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
5334 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
5335 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
5336 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02005337
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005338 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
5339 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
5340 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
5341 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
5342 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01005343
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005344 Example:
5345 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
5346
5347 # applied to:
5348 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
5349
5350 # outputs:
5351 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
5352
5353 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005354
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005355 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
5356
5357 # applied to:
5358 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005359
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005360 # outputs:
5361 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005362
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005363http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5364 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5365
5366 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
5367 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
5368 after an optional scheme+authority. It does contain the query string if any
5369 is present. The replacement does not modify the scheme nor authority.
5370
5371 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
5372 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
5373 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
5374
5375 Example:
5376 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
5377 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
5378
5379 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
5380 http-request replace-path ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
5381
5382 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
5383 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
5384 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
5385 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
5386
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005387http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5388 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5389
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005390 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
5391 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
5392 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
5393 against.
5394
5395 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
5396 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
5397 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005398
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005399 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
5400 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
5401 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
5402 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
5403 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
5404 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
5405 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
5406 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
5407 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01005408 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
5409 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005410
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005411 Example:
5412 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
5413 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005414
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01005415 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
5416 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02005417
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005418http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
5419 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005420
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005421 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
5422 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
5423 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
5424 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02005425
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005426 Example:
5427 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02005428
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005429 # applied to:
5430 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02005431
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01005432 # outputs:
5433 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01005434
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005435http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
5436 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5437 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01005438 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005439 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5440
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005441 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005442 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
5443 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
5444 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itselft may
5445 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005446 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005447 are followed to create the response :
5448
5449 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
5450 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
5451 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
5452 ignored.
5453
5454 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
5455 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005456 status code handled by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
5457 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any,
5458 is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005459
5460 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
5461 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
5462 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005463 by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503,
5464 and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005465
5466 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
5467 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
5468 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
5469 must be one of the status code handled by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005470 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
5471 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005472
5473 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
5474 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
5475 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
5476 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
5477 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
5478 as a raw content.
5479
5480 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
5481 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
5482 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
5483 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
5484 considered as a raw string.
5485
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01005486 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
5487 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
5488 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
5489 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
5490
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005491 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
5492 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005493 reserved to the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01005494
5495 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
5496
5497 Example:
5498 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproy/errorfiles/200.http \
5499 if { path /ping }
5500
5501 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
5502 if { path /favicon.ico }
5503
5504 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
5505 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
5506 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
5507
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005508http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5509http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005510
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005511 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
5512 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
5513 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005514
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005515http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
5516 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005517
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01005518 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
5519 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
5520 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
5521 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005522
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005523http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02005524
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005525 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
5526 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
5527 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
5528 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
5529 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005530
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005531 Arguments:
5532 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
5533 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005534
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005535 Example:
5536 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
5537 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01005538
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005539 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
5540 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005541
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005542http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005543
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005544 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
5545 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
5546 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005547
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005548 Arguments:
5549 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5550 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005551
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005552 Example:
5553 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
5554 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02005555
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005556 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
5557 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
5558 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005559
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005560http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005561
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005562 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
5563 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
5564 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
5565 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
5566 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005567
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005568 Example:
5569 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
5570 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
5571 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
5572 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
5573 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
5574 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
5575 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
5576 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
5577 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005578
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005579http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02005580
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005581 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
5582 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
5583 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
5584 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
5585 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005586
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005587http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
5588 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005589
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005590 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5591 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5592 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
5593 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
5594 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
5595 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
5596 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
5597 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
5598 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005599
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005600http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005601
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005602 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
5603 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
5604 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
5605 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
5606 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
5607 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
5608 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02005609
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005610http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005611
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005612 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
5613 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
5614 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005615
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005616http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005617
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005618 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
5619 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
5620 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
5621 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
5622 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
5623 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
5624 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
5625 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02005626
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005627http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02005628
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005629 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
5630 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
5631 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
5632 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
5633 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
5634 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02005635
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005636 Example :
5637 # prepend the host name before the path
5638 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005639
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005640http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02005641
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005642 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
5643 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
5644 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
5645 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
5646 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005647
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005648http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005649
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005650 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
5651 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
5652 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
5653 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
5654 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
5655 values have higher priority.
5656 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
5657 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
5658 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
5659 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
5660 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02005661
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005662http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005663
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005664 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
5665 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
5666 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
5667 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
5668 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
5669 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
5670 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08005671
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005672 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005673
5674 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005675 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
5676 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005677
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005678http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5679 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
5680 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
5681 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02005682 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
5683 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005684
5685 Arguments :
5686 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
5687 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005688
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02005689 See also "option forwardfor".
5690
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01005691 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005692 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
5693 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
5694
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02005695 # After the masking this will track connections
5696 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
5697 http-request track-sc0 src
5698
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005699 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
5700 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
5701
5702http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5703
5704 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
5705 expression.
5706
5707 Arguments:
5708 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
5709 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005710
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005711 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005712 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
5713 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
5714
5715 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
5716 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
5717 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
5718
5719http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5720
5721 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
5722 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
5723 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
5724 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
5725 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
5726 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
5727 information from the request.
5728
5729 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
5730
5731http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5732
5733 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
5734 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
5735 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
5736 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
5737 path and the query string.
5738 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
5739
5740http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5741
5742 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5743 inline.
5744
5745 Arguments:
5746 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5747 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5748 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5749 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5750 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5751 (request and response)
5752 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5753 processing
5754 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5755 processing
5756 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5757 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
5758 and '_'.
5759
5760 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5761 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005762
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005763 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005764 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005765
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005766http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
5767 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005768
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005769 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
5770 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
5771 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
5772 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
5773 agent name must be used.
5774
5775 Arguments:
5776 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
5777
5778 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
5779 configuration.
5780
5781http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5782
5783 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
5784 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
5785 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
5786 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
5787 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
5788 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
5789 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
5790 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
5791 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
5792 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
5793 action.
5794 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
5795 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
5796 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
5797 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
5798 you fully understand how it works.
5799
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005800http-request strict-mode { on | off }
5801
5802 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
5803 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
5804 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
5805 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
5806 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005807 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005808 processing.
5809
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01005810 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01005811 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
5812 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
5813 rules evaluation.
5814
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005815http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5816http-request tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
5817 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5818 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5819 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5820 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005821
5822 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
5823 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
5824 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005825 is still connected, a response is returned so that the client does not
5826 suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT". The goal of
5827 the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when they're limited
5828 on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very efficient against very
5829 dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load on firewalls compared to
5830 a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly" developed robots, it can make
5831 things worse by forcing haproxy and the front firewall to support insane
5832 number of concurrent connections. By default an HTTP error 500 is returned.
5833 But the response may be customized using same syntax than
5834 "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request return" for details.
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005835 For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined, or only "deny_status",
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005836 the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
5837 "http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
5838 "http-request tarpit [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
5839 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
5840 See also "http-request return" and "http-request silent-drop".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005841
5842http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5843http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5844http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5845
5846 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
5847 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
5848 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
5849 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
5850 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first
5851 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
5852 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
5853 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
5854 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
5855 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
5856 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
5857 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
5858
5859 Arguments :
5860 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
5861 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
5862 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
5863 select which table entry to update the counters.
5864
5865 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
5866 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
5867 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
5868 that table until the session ends.
5869
5870 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
5871 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
5872 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
5873 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
5874 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
5875 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
5876 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
5877 useful information.
5878
5879 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
5880 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
5881 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
5882 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
5883 checks that make use of it.
5884
5885http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5886
5887 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005888
5889 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005890 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005891
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01005892http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5893
5894 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
5895 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
5896 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
5897 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
5898 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
5899 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
5900
5901 Arguments :
5902 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
5903
5904 Example:
5905 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
5906
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005907http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005908
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005909 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
5910 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
5911 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02005912
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005913
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005914http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005915 Access control for Layer 7 responses
5916
5917 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5918 no | yes | yes | yes
5919
5920 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5921 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5922 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5923 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5924 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
5925 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
5926
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005927 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5928 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005929
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005930 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02005931
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005932 Example:
5933 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02005934
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005935 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005936
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005937 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
5938 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005939
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005940 Example:
5941 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005942
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005943 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005944
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005945 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
5946 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005947
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005948 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
5949 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005950
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005951http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005952
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005953 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5954 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5955 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5956 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
5957 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
5958 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5959 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5960 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005961
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005962http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005963
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005964 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
5965 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
5966 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
5967 example, or to pass some internal information.
5968 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
5969 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
5970 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005971
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005972http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005973
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005974 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
5975 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005976
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02005977http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005978
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02005979 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005980
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005981http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005982
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005983 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
5984 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
5985 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
5986 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
5987 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
5988 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
5989 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02005990
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02005991 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
5992 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
5993 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
5994 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
5995 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01005996
5997 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
5998 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
5999 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
6000 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006001
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006002http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006003
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006004 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6005 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6006 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6007 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6008 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6009 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02006010
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006011http-response del-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02006012
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006013 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02006014
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006015http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02006016
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006017 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6018 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6019 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6020 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6021 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
6022 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006023
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006024http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6025http-response deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6026 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6027 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6028 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6029 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006030
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006031 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response.
6032 By default an HTTP 502 error is returned. But the response may be customized
6033 using same syntax than "http-response return" rules. Thus, see
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006034 "http-response return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006035 argument is defined, or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles"
6036 is implied. It means "http-response deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias
6037 of "http-response deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01006038 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006039 See also "http-response return".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006040
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006041http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006042
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006043 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
6044 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
6045 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
6046 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
6047 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
6048 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02006049
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006050http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
6051 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02006052
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006053 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
6054 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01006055
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006056 Example:
6057 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02006058
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006059 # applied to:
6060 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006061
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006062 # outputs:
6063 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006064
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006065 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006066
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006067http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
6068 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006069
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01006070 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006071 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006072
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006073 Example:
6074 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006075
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006076 # applied to:
6077 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006078
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006079 # outputs:
6080 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006081
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006082http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
6083 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6084 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006085 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006086 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6087
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006088 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006089 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
6090 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
6091 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itselft may
6092 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006093 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006094 are followed to create the response :
6095
6096 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
6097 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
6098 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
6099 ignored.
6100
6101 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
6102 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006103 status code handled by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
6104 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any,
6105 is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006106
6107 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
6108 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
6109 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006110 by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503,
6111 and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006112
6113 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
6114 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
6115 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
6116 must be one of the status code handled by hparoxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006117 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
6118 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006119
6120 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
6121 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
6122 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
6123 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
6124 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
6125 as a raw content.
6126
6127 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
6128 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
6129 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
6130 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
6131 considered as a raw string.
6132
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006133 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
6134 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
6135 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
6136 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
6137
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006138 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
6139 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006140 reserved to the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006141
6142 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
6143
6144 Example:
6145 http-response return errorfile /etc/haproy/errorfiles/200.http \
6146 if { status eq 404 }
6147
6148 http-response return content-type text/plain \
6149 string "This is the end !" \
6150 if { status eq 500 }
6151
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006152http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6153http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08006154
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006155 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
6156 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
6157 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02006158
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006159http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6160 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02006161
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006162 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
6163 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
6164 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
6165 evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01006166
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006167http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02006168
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006169 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
6170 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
6171 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
6172 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
6173 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006174
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006175 Arguments:
6176 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006177
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006178 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
6179 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006180
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006181http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006182
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006183 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
6184 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
6185 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006186
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006187http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6188
6189 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
6190 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
6191 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
6192 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
6193 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
6194
6195http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6196
6197 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6198 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6199 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
6200 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
6201 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
6202 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
6203 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6204 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
6205 be triggered by an HTTP response.
6206
6207http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6208
6209 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
6210 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
6211 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
6212 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
6213 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
6214 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
6215 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
6216
6217http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6218
6219 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
6220 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
6221 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
6222 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
6223 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
6224 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
6225 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
6226 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
6227
6228http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
6229 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6230
6231 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
6232 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
6233 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
6234 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006235
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006236 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006237 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
6238 http-response set-status 431
6239 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
6240 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006241
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006242http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006243
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006244 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
6245 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
6246 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
6247 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
6248 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
6249 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
6250 based on some information from the request.
6251
6252 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
6253
6254http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6255
6256 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6257 inline.
6258
6259 Arguments:
6260 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6261 scope. The scopes allowed are:
6262 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
6263 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
6264 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
6265 (request and response)
6266 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
6267 processing
6268 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
6269 processing
6270 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6271 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
6272 and '_'.
6273
6274 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6275 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006276
6277 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006278 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006279
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006280http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006281
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006282 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
6283 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
6284 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
6285 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
6286 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
6287 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
6288 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
6289 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
6290 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
6291 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
6292 action.
6293 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
6294 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
6295 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
6296 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
6297 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006298
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006299http-response strict-mode { on | off }
6300
6301 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
6302 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
6303 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
6304 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
6305 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006306 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006307 processing.
6308
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01006309 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006310 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
6311 the bacnkend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
6312 rules evaluation.
6313
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006314http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6315http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6316http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006317
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006318 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
6319 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
6320 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
6321 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
6322 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
6323 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
6324
6325http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6326
6327 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
6328 about <var-name>.
6329
6330 Example:
6331 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
6332
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02006333
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006334http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
6335 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
6336
6337 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6338 yes | no | yes | yes
6339
6340 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006341 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
6342 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
6343 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006344
6345 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
6346
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006347 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
6348 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
6349 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
6350 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
6351 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
6352 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
6353 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
6354 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
6355 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
6356 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006357
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01006358 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
6359 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
6360 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
6361 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
6362 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
6363 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
6364 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
6365 effects.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006366
6367 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
6368 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
6369 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
6370 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
6371 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
6372 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
6373 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
6374 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02006375 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006376 downsides of rare connection failures.
6377
6378 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
6379 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
6380 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
6381 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
6382 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
6383 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006384 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006385 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
6386 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
6387 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
6388 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
6389 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
6390
6391 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006392 connection properties and compatibility. Specifically :
6393 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependent value
6394 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006395
6396 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006397 and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006398
Lukas Tribusfd9b68c2018-10-27 20:06:59 +02006399 - connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying on the
6400 connection) like NTLM are detected, marked private and are never shared;
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006401
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01006402 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02006403
6404 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
6405 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
6406 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
6407
6408 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
6409
6410
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006411http-send-name-header [<header>]
6412 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006413 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6414 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006415 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006416 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
6417
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02006418 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
6419 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
6420 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
6421 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
6422 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
6423 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
6424 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
6425 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
6426 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
6427 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
6428 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
6429 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
6430 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
6431 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
6432 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
6433 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05006434
6435 See also : "server"
6436
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01006437id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02006438 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
6439 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6440 no | yes | yes | yes
6441 Arguments : none
6442
6443 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
6444 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
6445 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01006446
6447
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006448ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
6449 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
6450 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01006451 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006452
6453 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
6454 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
6455 and running).
6456
6457 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
6458 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
6459 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006460 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006461 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
6462
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006463 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
6464 "unless" condition is met.
6465
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03006466 Example:
6467 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
6468 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
6469 ignore-persist if url_static
6470
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006471 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
6472
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006473load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
6474 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
6475 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6476 yes | no | yes | yes
6477
6478 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
6479 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
6480 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006481 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006482 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
6483 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
6484 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
6485 over the stats socket and redirect output.
6486
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006487 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006488 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02006489 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006490
6491 Arguments:
6492 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
6493 named "server-state-file".
6494
6495 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
6496 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
6497 name is used as a file name.
6498
6499 none don't load any stat for this backend
6500
6501 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01006502 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
6503 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
6504 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006505 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01006506 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006507
6508 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
6509 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
6510
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006511 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006512
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006513 global
6514 stats socket /tmp/socket
6515 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006516
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006517 defaults
6518 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006519
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006520 backend bk
6521 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
6522 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006523
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006524
6525 Then one can run :
6526
6527 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
6528
6529 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
6530
6531 1
6532 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
6533 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6534 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6535
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006536 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006537
6538 global
6539 stats socket /tmp/socket
6540 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
6541
6542 defaults
6543 load-server-state-from-file local
6544
6545 backend bk
6546 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
6547 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
6548
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02006549
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02006550 Then one can run :
6551
6552 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
6553
6554 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
6555
6556 1
6557 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
6558 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6559 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
6560
6561 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
6562 "show servers state"
6563
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006564
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006565log global
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02006566log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>]
6567 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02006568no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006569 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
6570 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6571 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02006572
6573 Prefix :
6574 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
6575 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
6576 prefix does not allow arguments.
6577
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006578 Arguments :
6579 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
6580 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
6581 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
6582 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
6583 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
6584 parameter.
6585
6586 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
6587 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
6588
6589 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
6590 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
6591 standard syslog port).
6592
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01006593 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
6594 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
6595 standard syslog port).
6596
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006597 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
6598 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
6599 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006600 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006601
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01006602 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
6603 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
6604 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
6605 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
6606 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
6607 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
6608 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
6609 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
6610 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
6611 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
6612 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
6613 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
6614 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
6615 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
6616 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
6617 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006618 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
6619 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01006620
6621 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
6622 and "fd@2", see above.
6623
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02006624 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
6625 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
6626 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
6627 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
6628 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
6629 having the logs instantly available.
6630
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01006631 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
6632 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006633
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02006634 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
6635 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
6636 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
6637 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
6638 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
6639 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
6640 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
6641 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
6642 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
6643 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006644 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02006645
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02006646 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
6647 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
6648 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
6649 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
6650 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
6651
6652 <sample_size>
6653 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
6654 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
6655 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
6656 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
6657 (see also <ranges> parameter).
6658
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01006659 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
6660 one of the following :
6661
6662 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
6663 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
6664
6665 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
6666 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
6667
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01006668 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
6669 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
6670 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
6671 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
6672 systemd logger consumes.
6673
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006674 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
6675 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
6676 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
6677 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
6678
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006679 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
6680
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01006681 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
6682 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
6683 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
6684
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006685 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
6686 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
6687 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
6688 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006689
6690 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
6691 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
6692 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02006693 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
6694 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
6695 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
6696 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
6697 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006698
6699 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
6700
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02006701 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
6702 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
6703 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01006704
6705 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
6706 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
6707 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
6708 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
6709
6710 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
6711 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006712
6713 Example :
6714 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01006715 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
6716 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
6717 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02006718 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
6719 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02006720 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01006721
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006722
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01006723log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01006724 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
6725 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6726 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01006727
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01006728 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
6729 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
6730 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
6731 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
6732 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01006733
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006734 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
6735 "option httplog" directives.
6736
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02006737log-format-sd <string>
6738 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
6739 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6740 yes | yes | yes | no
6741
6742 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
6743 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
6744 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
6745 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
6746 which covers the log format string in depth.
6747
6748 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
6749 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
6750
6751 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
6752 log format to "rfc5424".
6753
6754 Example :
6755 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
6756
6757
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01006758log-tag <string>
6759 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
6760 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6761 yes | yes | yes | yes
6762
6763 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
6764 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
6765 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
6766 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
6767 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
6768 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
6769 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
6770 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
6771 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006772
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02006773max-keep-alive-queue <value>
6774 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
6775 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6776 yes | no | yes | yes
6777
6778 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
6779 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
6780 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
6781 servers.
6782
6783 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
6784 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
6785 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
6786 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
6787 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006788 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02006789 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
6790 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
6791 picking a different server.
6792
6793 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
6794 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
6795 even if they have to be queued.
6796
6797 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
6798 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
6799
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01006800max-session-srv-conns <nb>
6801 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
6802 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
6803 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02006804
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006805maxconn <conns>
6806 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
6807 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6808 yes | yes | yes | no
6809 Arguments :
6810 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
6811 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
6812 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
6813 closes.
6814
6815 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
6816 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
6817 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
6818 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01006819 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
6820 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
6821 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
6822 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006823
6824 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
6825 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
6826 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
6827
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01006828 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
6829 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02006830
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006831 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
6832
6833
6834mode { tcp|http|health }
6835 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
6836 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6837 yes | yes | yes | yes
6838 Arguments :
6839 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
6840 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
6841 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
6842 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
6843
6844 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
6845 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
6846 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
6847 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
6848 brings HAProxy most of its value.
6849
6850 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02006851 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
6852 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
6853 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
6854 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
6855 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
6856 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
6857 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006858
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006859 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
6860 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
6861 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006862
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006863 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006864 defaults http_instances
6865 mode http
6866
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006867 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006868
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006869
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01006870monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006871 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006872 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6873 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006874 Arguments :
6875 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
6876 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006877 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006878 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
6879 backend and its backup.
6880
6881 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
6882 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
6883 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
6884 servers in a list of backends.
6885
6886 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
6887 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
6888 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
6889 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
6890 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
6891 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
6892 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02006893 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
6894 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006895
6896 Example:
6897 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006898 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006899 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
6900 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
6901 monitor-uri /site_alive
6902 monitor fail if site_dead
6903
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02006904 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006905
6906
6907monitor-net <source>
6908 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
6909 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6910 yes | yes | yes | no
6911 Arguments :
6912 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
6913 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
6914 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
6915 followed by a mask.
6916
6917 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
6918 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006919 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006920 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
6921
6922 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
6923 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
6924 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
6925 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02006926 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
6927 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
6928 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006929
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02006930 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
6931 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
6932 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
6933 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
6934 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
6935 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006936
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01006937 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
6938 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006939
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006940 Example :
6941 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
6942 frontend www
6943 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
6944
6945 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
6946
6947
6948monitor-uri <uri>
6949 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
6950 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6951 yes | yes | yes | no
6952 Arguments :
6953 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
6954 health status instead of forwarding the request.
6955
6956 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
6957 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
6958 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
6959 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
6960 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
6961 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
6962 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
6963 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
6964
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01006965 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006966 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
6967 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
6968 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
6969 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
6970 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
6971 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006972
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01006973 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
6974 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
6975 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
6976 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
6977
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006978 Example :
6979 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
6980 frontend www
6981 mode http
6982 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
6983
6984 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
6985
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006986
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006987option abortonclose
6988no option abortonclose
6989 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
6990 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6991 yes | no | yes | yes
6992 Arguments : none
6993
6994 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
6995 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
6996 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
6997 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006998 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006999 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
7000 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
7001 encountered while delivering the response.
7002
7003 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
7004 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
7005 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
7006 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
7007 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
7008 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007009 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007010 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007011 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007012 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
7013 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
7014 still not served and not pollute the servers.
7015
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007016 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
7017 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007018 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
7019 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
7020 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
7021 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
7022 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
7023 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007024 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007025
7026 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7027 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7028
7029 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
7030
7031
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007032option accept-invalid-http-request
7033no option accept-invalid-http-request
7034 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
7035 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7036 yes | yes | yes | no
7037 Arguments : none
7038
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007039 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007040 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007041 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007042 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
7043 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
7044 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
7045 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
7046 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01007047 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
7048 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
7049 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
7050 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007051 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007052 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02007053 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
7054 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
7055 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007056
7057 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
7058 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
7059 been confirmed.
7060
7061 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
7062 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01007063 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
7064 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007065 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
7066
7067 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7068 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7069
7070 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
7071 stats socket.
7072
7073
7074option accept-invalid-http-response
7075no option accept-invalid-http-response
7076 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
7077 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7078 yes | no | yes | yes
7079 Arguments : none
7080
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007081 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007082 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007083 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007084 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
7085 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
7086 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
7087 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
7088 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007089 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
7090 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
7091 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007092
7093 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
7094 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
7095 been confirmed.
7096
7097 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
7098 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
7099 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
7100 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
7101
7102 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7103 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7104
7105 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
7106 stats socket.
7107
7108
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007109option allbackups
7110no option allbackups
7111 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
7112 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7113 yes | no | yes | yes
7114 Arguments : none
7115
7116 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
7117 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
7118 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
7119 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
7120 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
7121 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
7122 order between the backup servers anymore.
7123
7124 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
7125 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
7126
7127 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7128 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7129
7130
7131option checkcache
7132no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08007133 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007134 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7135 yes | no | yes | yes
7136 Arguments : none
7137
7138 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
7139 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007140 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007141 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
7142 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007143 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007144
7145 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007146 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007147 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007148 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
7149 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007150 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007151 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01007152 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
7153 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007154 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01007155 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
7156 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007157 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007158 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
7159 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
7160 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
7161 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
7162 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
7163 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
7164 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
7165 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
7166 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
7167
7168 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007169 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
7170 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
7171 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
7172 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007173
7174 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
7175 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007176 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007177 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007178
7179 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7180 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7181
7182
7183option clitcpka
7184no option clitcpka
7185 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
7186 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7187 yes | yes | yes | no
7188 Arguments : none
7189
7190 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7191 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007192 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007193 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7194
7195 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7196 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7197 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7198 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7199
7200 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7201 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7202 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7203 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7204 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7205
7206 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7207
7208 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
7209 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
7210 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
7211
7212 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7213 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7214
7215 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
7216
7217
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007218option contstats
7219 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
7220 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7221 yes | yes | yes | no
7222 Arguments : none
7223
7224 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
7225 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
7226 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
7227 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01007228 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
7229 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
7230 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
7231 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
7232 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007233
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02007234option disable-h2-upgrade
7235no option disable-h2-upgrade
7236 Enable or disable the implicit HTTP/2 upgrade from an HTTP/1.x client
7237 connection.
7238 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7239 yes | yes | yes | no
7240 Arguments : none
7241
7242 By default, HAProxy is able to implicitly upgrade an HTTP/1.x client
7243 connection to an HTTP/2 connection if the first request it receives from a
7244 given HTTP connection matches the HTTP/2 connection preface (i.e. the string
7245 "PRI * HTTP/2.0\r\n\r\nSM\r\n\r\n"). This way, it is possible to support
7246 HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 clients on a non-SSL connections. This option must be used to
7247 disable the implicit upgrade. Note this implicit upgrade is only supported
7248 for HTTP proxies, thus this option too. Note also it is possible to force the
7249 HTTP/2 on clear connections by specifying "proto h2" on the bind line.
7250
7251 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7252 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007253
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007254option dontlog-normal
7255no option dontlog-normal
7256 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
7257 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7258 yes | yes | yes | no
7259 Arguments : none
7260
7261 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
7262 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
7263 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
7264 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
7265 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
7266 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
7267 logged.
7268
7269 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
7270 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
7271 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
7272
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007273 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007274 logging.
7275
7276
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007277option dontlognull
7278no option dontlognull
7279 Enable or disable logging of null connections
7280 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7281 yes | yes | yes | no
7282 Arguments : none
7283
7284 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
7285 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
7286 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
7287 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
7288 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
7289 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007290 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
7291 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
7292 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007293
7294 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007295 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007296 would not be logged.
7297
7298 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7299 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7300
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007301 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
7302 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007303
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007304
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007305option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007306 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
7307 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7308 yes | yes | yes | yes
7309 Arguments :
7310 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
7311 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007312 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007313 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007314
7315 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
7316 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
7317 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
7318 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
7319 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
7320 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
7321 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007322 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
7323 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
7324 possible that the client has already brought one.
7325
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007326 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007327 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007328 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007329 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007330 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007331 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007332
7333 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
7334 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
7335 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
7336 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
7337 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
7338 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
7339 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
7340
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007341 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
7342 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
7343 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
7344 are under the control of the end-user.
7345
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007346 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007347 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
7348 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007349 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
7350 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
7351 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007352
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007353 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007354 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
7355 frontend www
7356 mode http
7357 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
7358
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02007359 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
7360 backend www
7361 mode http
7362 option forwardfor header X-Client
7363
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02007364 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007365 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007366
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007367
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02007368option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
7369no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
7370 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
7371 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7372 yes | yes | yes | no
7373 Arguments : none
7374
7375 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
7376 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
7377 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
7378 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
7379 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
7380 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
7381 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
7382
7383 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
7384 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
7385 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
7386 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
7387 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
7388 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
7389 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
7390 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
7391 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
7392 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
7393
7394 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
7395
7396 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7397 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7398
7399 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
7400 "h1-case-adjust-file".
7401
7402
7403option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
7404no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
7405 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
7406 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7407 yes | no | yes | yes
7408 Arguments : none
7409
7410 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
7411 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
7412 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
7413 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
7414 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
7415 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
7416 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
7417
7418 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
7419 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
7420 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
7421 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
7422 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
7423 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
7424 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
7425 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
7426 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
7427 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
7428
7429 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
7430
7431 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7432 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7433
7434 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
7435 "h1-case-adjust-file".
7436
7437
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007438option http-buffer-request
7439no option http-buffer-request
7440 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
7441 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7442 yes | yes | yes | yes
7443 Arguments : none
7444
7445 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
7446 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
7447 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
7448 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
7449 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
7450 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01007451 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
7452 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
7453 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
7454 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007455
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01007456 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007457
7458
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007459option http-ignore-probes
7460no option http-ignore-probes
7461 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
7462 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7463 yes | yes | yes | no
7464 Arguments : none
7465
7466 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
7467 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
7468 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
7469 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
7470 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
7471 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
7472 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
7473 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
7474 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007475 was received over a connection before it was closed;
7476 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02007477 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
7478
7479 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
7480 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
7481 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
7482 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
7483 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
7484 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
7485 are often the only way to detect them.
7486
7487 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7488 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7489
7490 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
7491
7492
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007493option http-keep-alive
7494no option http-keep-alive
7495 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
7496 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7497 yes | yes | yes | yes
7498 Arguments : none
7499
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007500 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
7501 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007502 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
7503 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007504 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
7505 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
7506 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007507
7508 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
7509 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007510 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
7511 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
7512 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
7513 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
7514 situations where this option may be useful :
7515
7516 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007517 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007518
7519 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
7520 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
7521
7522 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
7523 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
7524 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
7525 request.
7526
7527 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
7528 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007529 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
7530 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
7531 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007532
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007533 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
7534 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
7535 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
7536 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
7537 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
7538 not set.
7539
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007540 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
7541 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
7542 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007543
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007544 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01007545 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01007546 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007547
7548
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02007549option http-no-delay
7550no option http-no-delay
7551 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
7552 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7553 yes | yes | yes | yes
7554 Arguments : none
7555
7556 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
7557 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
7558 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
7559 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
7560 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
7561 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
7562 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
7563 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
7564 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
7565 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
7566 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
7567 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
7568 affected.
7569
7570 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
7571 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
7572 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
7573 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
7574 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
7575 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
7576 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
7577 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
7578 latency environments.
7579
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02007580 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
7581
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02007582
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007583option http-pretend-keepalive
7584no option http-pretend-keepalive
7585 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
7586 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02007587 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007588 Arguments : none
7589
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007590 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007591 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
7592 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
7593 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
7594 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
7595 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
7596 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
7597 consider the response complete.
7598
7599 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
7600 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
7601 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
7602 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007603 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007604 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
7605
7606 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
7607 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
7608 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
7609 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
7610 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
7611 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
7612 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
7613
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02007614 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
7615 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
7616 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
7617 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
7618 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
7619 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007620
7621 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7622 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7623
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007624 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01007625 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02007626
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007627
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007628option http-server-close
7629no option http-server-close
7630 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
7631 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7632 yes | yes | yes | yes
7633 Arguments : none
7634
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007635 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
7636 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
7637 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
7638 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007639 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
7640 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
7641 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
7642 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
7643 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
7644 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
7645 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
7646 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
7647 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
7648 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
7649 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007650
7651 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
7652 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
7653 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
7654 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01007655 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
7656 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007657
7658 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
7659 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007660 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
7661 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
7662 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007663
7664 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7665 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7666
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007667 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
7668 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01007669
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007670option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007671no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007672 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
7673 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7674 yes | yes | yes | no
7675 Arguments : none
7676
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00007677 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007678 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
7679 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
7680 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
7681 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
7682 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
7683 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
7684
7685 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
7686 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01007687 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
7688 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
7689 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007690
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01007691 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
7692 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
7693 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
7694 front of an existing proxy.
7695
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007696 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
7697
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007698 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01007699
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007700option httpchk
7701option httpchk <uri>
7702option httpchk <method> <uri>
7703option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02007704 Enables HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007705 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7706 yes | no | yes | yes
7707 Arguments :
7708 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
7709 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
7710 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
7711 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
7712 ones.
7713
7714 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
7715 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
7716 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
7717
7718 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
7719 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
7720 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02007721 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007722
7723 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
7724 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
7725 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
7726 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
7727 the lack of any response.
7728
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02007729 Combined with "http-check" directives, it is possible to customize the
7730 request sent during the HTTP health checks or the matching rules on the
7731 response. It is also possible to configure a send/expect sequence, just like
7732 with the directive "tcp-check" for TCP health checks.
7733
7734 The server configuration is used by default to open connections to perform
7735 HTTP health checks. By it is also possible to overwrite server parameters
7736 using "http-check connect" rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007737
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02007738 "httpchk" option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works
7739 with plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02007740 bound to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon. However, it will always
7741 internally relies on an HTX mutliplexer. Thus, it means the request
7742 formatting and the response parsing will be strict.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007743
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02007744 Note : For a while, there was no way to add headers or body in the request
7745 used for HTTP health checks. So a workaround was to hide it at the end
7746 of the version string with a "\r\n" after the version. It is now
7747 deprecated. The directive "http-check send" must be used instead.
7748
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007749 Examples :
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02007750 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
7751 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
7752 backend https_relay
7753 mode tcp
7754 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
7755 http-check send hdr Host www
7756 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007757
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09007758 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
7759 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
7760 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007761
7762
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007763option httpclose
7764no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007765 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007766 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7767 yes | yes | yes | yes
7768 Arguments : none
7769
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007770 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
7771 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
7772 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
7773 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007774 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01007775
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007776 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
7777 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05007778 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007779 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
7780 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007781
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007782 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
7783 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
7784 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007785
7786 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
7787 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02007788 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
7789 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
7790 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007791
7792 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7793 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7794
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02007795 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007796
7797
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007798option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007799 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
7800 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01007801 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007802 Arguments :
7803 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
7804 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
7805 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007806 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007807 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007808
7809 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
7810 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
7811 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
7812 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
7813 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
7814 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
7815 ports.
7816
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01007817 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
7818 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02007819
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007820 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
7821
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007822 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007823
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007824
7825option http_proxy
7826no option http_proxy
7827 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
7828 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7829 yes | yes | yes | yes
7830 Arguments : none
7831
7832 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
7833 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
7834 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
7835 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
7836 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
7837
7838 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
7839 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01007840 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
7841 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02007842
7843 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7844 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7845
7846 Example :
7847 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
7848 backend direct_forward
7849 option httpclose
7850 option http_proxy
7851
7852 See also : "option httpclose"
7853
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007854
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007855option independent-streams
7856no option independent-streams
7857 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02007858 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7859 yes | yes | yes | yes
7860 Arguments : none
7861
7862 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
7863 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
7864 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
7865 receive data or not.
7866
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007867 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02007868 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
7869 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
7870 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
7871 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
7872 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
7873 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
7874 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
7875 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
7876 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
7877 socket buffers.
7878
7879 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
7880 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
7881 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
7882 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
7883 slow lines, so use it with caution.
7884
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007885 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02007886
7887
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02007888option ldap-check
7889 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
7890 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7891 yes | no | yes | yes
7892 Arguments : none
7893
7894 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
7895 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
7896 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
7897 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
7898
7899 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
7900 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
7901
7902 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
7903 configure it.
7904
7905 Example :
7906 option ldap-check
7907
7908 See also : "option httpchk"
7909
7910
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09007911option external-check
7912 Use external processes for server health checks
7913 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7914 yes | no | yes | yes
7915
7916 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
7917 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
7918 command".
7919
7920 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
7921
7922 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
7923
7924
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007925option log-health-checks
7926no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007927 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007928 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7929 yes | no | yes | yes
7930 Arguments : none
7931
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007932 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
7933 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
7934 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007935
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007936 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
7937 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
7938 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
7939 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
7940 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
7941
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007942 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007943 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007944
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02007945 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
7946 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
7947 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02007948
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007949
7950option log-separate-errors
7951no option log-separate-errors
7952 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
7953 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7954 yes | yes | yes | no
7955 Arguments : none
7956
7957 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
7958 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
7959 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
7960 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
7961 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
7962 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
7963 provides very important information.
7964
7965 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
7966 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
7967 error logs.
7968
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007969 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02007970 logging.
7971
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007972
7973option logasap
7974no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02007975 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007976 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7977 yes | yes | yes | no
7978 Arguments : none
7979
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02007980 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
7981 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
7982 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
7983 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
7984
7985 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
7986 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
7987 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
7988 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
7989 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05007990 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transferred
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02007991 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
7992 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
7993 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
7994 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05007995 transferred.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01007996
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007997 Examples :
7998 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
7999 mode http
8000 option httplog
8001 option logasap
8002 log 192.168.2.200 local3
8003
8004 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
8005 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
8006 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
8007 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
8008
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008009 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008010 logging.
8011
8012
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02008013option mysql-check [ user <username> [ { post-41 | pre-41 } ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008014 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008015 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8016 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008017 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008018 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
8019 server.
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02008020 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks (the default)
8021 pre-41 Send pre v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008022
8023 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
8024 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008025 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008026 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
8027 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
8028 in the MySQL table, like this :
8029
8030 USE mysql;
8031 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
8032 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
8033
8034 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008035 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008036 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
8037 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
8038 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
8039 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
8040 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
8041 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
8042 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
8043
8044 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
8045 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008046
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02008047 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008048
8049 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
8050 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
8051 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
8052 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02008053 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
8054 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008055
8056 See also: "option httpchk"
8057
8058
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008059option nolinger
8060no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008061 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008062 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8063 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008064 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008065
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008066 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008067 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
8068 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
8069 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
8070 connections.
8071
8072 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
8073 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
8074 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
8075 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
8076 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
8077 this too.
8078
8079 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
8080 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
8081 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
8082
8083 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
8084 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
8085 for servers.
8086
8087 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8088 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8089
8090
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008091option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
8092 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
8093 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8094 yes | yes | yes | yes
8095 Arguments :
8096 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
8097 matching <network>
8098 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
8099 header name.
8100
8101 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
8102 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
8103 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
8104 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
8105 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
8106 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
8107 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
8108 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
8109 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
8110 possible that the client has already brought one.
8111
8112 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
8113 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
8114 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
8115 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
8116 header and requires different one.
8117
8118 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
8119 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
8120 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
8121 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
8122 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
8123 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
8124 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
8125
8126 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
8127 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
8128 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
8129 both are defined.
8130
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008131 Examples :
8132 # Original Destination address
8133 frontend www
8134 mode http
8135 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
8136
8137 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
8138 backend www
8139 mode http
8140 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
8141
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008142 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008143
8144
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008145option persist
8146no option persist
8147 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
8148 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8149 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008150 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008151
8152 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
8153 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
8154 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
8155 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
8156 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
8157 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
8158 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
8159 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
8160 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
8161 redirected to another valid server.
8162
8163 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8164 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8165
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01008166 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008167
8168
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01008169option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
8170 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
8171 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8172 yes | no | yes | yes
8173 Arguments :
8174 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
8175 PostgreSQL server.
8176
8177 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
8178 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
8179 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
8180 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
8181
8182 See also: "option httpchk"
8183
8184
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008185option prefer-last-server
8186no option prefer-last-server
8187 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
8188 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8189 yes | no | yes | yes
8190 Arguments : none
8191
8192 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
8193 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
8194 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
8195 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
8196 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
8197 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
8198 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
8199 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
8200 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01008201 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
8202 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02008203 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
8204 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
8205 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01008206 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
8207 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
8208 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008209
8210 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8211 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8212
8213 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
8214
8215
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008216option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008217option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008218no option redispatch
8219 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
8220 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8221 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008222 Arguments :
8223 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
8224 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
8225 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008226 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008227 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008228 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008229 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
8230 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
8231 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
8232
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008233
8234 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
8235 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
8236 be able to access the service anymore.
8237
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01008238 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
8239 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008240
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +02008241 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
8242 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
8243 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
8244 following order:
8245
8246 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
8247
8248 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
8249 list, or
8250
8251 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
8252
8253 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
8254 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
8255
8256 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
8257 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
8258 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
8259 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
8260
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07008261 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008262 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
8263 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008264
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008265 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8266 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8267
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008268 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008269
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008270
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02008271option redis-check
8272 Use redis health checks for server testing
8273 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8274 yes | no | yes | yes
8275 Arguments : none
8276
8277 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
8278 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
8279 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
8280 find the "+PONG" response message.
8281
8282 Example :
8283 option redis-check
8284
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03008285 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02008286
8287
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008288option smtpchk
8289option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
8290 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
8291 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8292 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008293 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008294 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02008295 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008296 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
8297
8298 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
8299 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
8300 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
8301
8302 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
8303 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
8304 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
8305 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
8306 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
8307 dead server.
8308
8309 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
8310 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008311 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008312 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
8313
8314 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
8315 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
8316 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
8317 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02008318 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008319
8320 Example :
8321 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
8322
8323 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
8324
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01008325
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02008326option socket-stats
8327no option socket-stats
8328
8329 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
8330 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8331 yes | yes | yes | no
8332
8333 Arguments : none
8334
8335
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008336option splice-auto
8337no option splice-auto
8338 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
8339 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8340 yes | yes | yes | yes
8341 Arguments : none
8342
8343 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
8344 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008345 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008346 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008347 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008348 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
8349 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
8350 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
8351 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8352
8353 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
8354 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
8355 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
8356 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
8357 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
8358 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
8359 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
8360 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
8361 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
8362 keyword.
8363
8364 Example :
8365 option splice-auto
8366
8367 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8368 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8369
8370 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
8371 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8372
8373
8374option splice-request
8375no option splice-request
8376 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
8377 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8378 yes | yes | yes | yes
8379 Arguments : none
8380
8381 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008382 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008383 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
8384 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
8385 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
8386 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8387
8388 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
8389
8390 Example :
8391 option splice-request
8392
8393 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8394 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8395
8396 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
8397 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8398
8399
8400option splice-response
8401no option splice-response
8402 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
8403 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8404 yes | yes | yes | yes
8405 Arguments : none
8406
8407 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008408 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01008409 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
8410 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
8411 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
8412 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
8413
8414 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
8415
8416 Example :
8417 option splice-response
8418
8419 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8420 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8421
8422 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
8423 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
8424
8425
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01008426option spop-check
8427 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
8428 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8429 no | no | no | yes
8430 Arguments : none
8431
8432 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
8433 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
8434 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
8435 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
8436
8437 Example :
8438 option spop-check
8439
8440 See also : "option httpchk"
8441
8442
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008443option srvtcpka
8444no option srvtcpka
8445 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
8446 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8447 yes | no | yes | yes
8448 Arguments : none
8449
8450 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8451 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008452 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008453 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8454
8455 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8456 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8457 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8458 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8459
8460 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8461 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8462 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8463 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8464 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8465
8466 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8467
8468 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
8469 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
8470 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
8471
8472 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8473 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8474
8475 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
8476
8477
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008478option ssl-hello-chk
8479 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
8480 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8481 yes | no | yes | yes
8482 Arguments : none
8483
8484 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
8485 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
8486 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
8487 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
8488 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
8489 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
8490 hello message.
8491
8492 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
8493 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
8494 messages, which is appreciable.
8495
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008496 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
8497 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
8498 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008499
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02008500 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
8501
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008502
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008503option tcp-check
8504 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
8505 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8506 yes | no | yes | yes
8507
8508 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
8509 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
8510
8511 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
8512 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
8513 attempt, which remains the default mode.
8514
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008515 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008516 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
8517 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
8518 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
8519 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
8520 only.
8521
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008522 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008523 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
8524 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
8525 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
8526 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
8527
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008528 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008529 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
8530 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008531 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008532 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
8533 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
8534 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
8535 the respective protocols.
8536 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008537 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008538
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008539 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the script.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008540
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008541 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
8542 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr in
8543 debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting. The
8544 "comment" is of course optional.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008545
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008546 During the execution of a health check, a variable scope is made available to
8547 store data samples, using the "tcp-check set-var" operation. Freeing those
8548 variable is possible using "tcp-check unset-var".
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +01008549
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008550
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008551 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008552 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008553 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008554 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008555
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008556 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008557 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008558 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008559
8560 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
8561 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008562 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008563 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008564 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008565 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02008566 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008567 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008568 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8569 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008570 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008571 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
8572 tcp-check expect string +OK
8573
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008574 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008575 (send many headers before analyzing)
8576 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008577 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008578 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
8579 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
8580 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
8581 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02008582 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008583
8584
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008585 See also : "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect" and "tcp-check send".
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01008586
8587
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02008588option tcp-smart-accept
8589no option tcp-smart-accept
8590 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
8591 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8592 yes | yes | yes | no
8593 Arguments : none
8594
8595 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
8596 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
8597 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
8598 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
8599 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
8600 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
8601
8602 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
8603 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
8604 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
8605 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
8606
8607 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
8608 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
8609 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008610 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02008611
8612 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
8613 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
8614 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
8615
8616 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
8617 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
8618 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
8619
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02008620 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
8621
8622
8623option tcp-smart-connect
8624no option tcp-smart-connect
8625 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
8626 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8627 yes | no | yes | yes
8628 Arguments : none
8629
8630 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
8631 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
8632 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
8633 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
8634 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
8635
8636 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
8637 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
8638 complex.
8639
8640 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
8641 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
8642 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
8643
8644 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8645 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8646
8647 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
8648
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02008649
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008650option tcpka
8651 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
8652 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8653 yes | yes | yes | yes
8654 Arguments : none
8655
8656 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8657 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008658 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008659 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8660
8661 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8662 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8663 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8664 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8665
8666 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8667 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8668 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8669 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8670 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8671
8672 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8673
8674 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
8675 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
8676 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
8677 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
8678 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
8679 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
8680 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
8681 backends.
8682
8683 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
8684
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008685
8686option tcplog
8687 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
8688 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01008689 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008690 Arguments : none
8691
8692 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8693 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8694 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
8695 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
8696 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
8697 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
8698 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
8699 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
8700
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008701 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8702
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008703 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008704
8705
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008706option transparent
8707no option transparent
8708 Enable client-side transparent proxying
8709 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01008710 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008711 Arguments : none
8712
8713 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
8714 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
8715 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
8716 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
8717 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
8718 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
8719 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
8720 appropriate server.
8721
8722 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
8723 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
8724
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01008725 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008726 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01008727
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008728
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008729external-check command <command>
8730 Executable to run when performing an external-check
8731 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8732 yes | no | yes | yes
8733
8734 Arguments :
8735 <command> is the external command to run
8736
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008737 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
8738
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01008739 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008740
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01008741 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
8742 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
8743 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
8744 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
8745 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
8746 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008747
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01008748 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
8749
8750 Environment variables :
8751 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
8752 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
8753
8754 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
8755
8756 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
8757
8758 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
8759 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
8760 for a UNIX socket).
8761
8762 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
8763
8764 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
8765
8766 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
8767
8768 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
8769
8770 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
8771
8772 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
8773 socket).
8774
8775 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
8776 the command may be set using "external-check path".
8777
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02008778 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
8779
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008780 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
8781 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
8782 failed.
8783
8784 Example :
8785 external-check command /bin/true
8786
8787 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
8788
8789
8790external-check path <path>
8791 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
8792 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8793 yes | no | yes | yes
8794
8795 Arguments :
8796 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
8797
8798 The default path is "".
8799
8800 Example :
8801 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
8802
8803 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
8804 "external-check command"
8805
8806
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008807persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02008808persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008809 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
8810 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8811 yes | no | yes | yes
8812 Arguments :
8813 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02008814 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
8815 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008816
8817 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
8818 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008819 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008820 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
8821 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
8822 forwarded to this server.
8823
8824 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
8825 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
8826 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008827 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008828 a single "listen" section.
8829
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02008830 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
8831 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
8832 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
8833
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008834 Example :
8835 listen tse-farm
8836 bind :3389
8837 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
8838 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8839 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
8840 # apply RDP cookie persistence
8841 persist rdp-cookie
8842 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008843 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008844 balance rdp-cookie
8845 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
8846 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
8847
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09008848 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
8849 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02008850
8851
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01008852rate-limit sessions <rate>
8853 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
8854 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8855 yes | yes | yes | no
8856 Arguments :
8857 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
8858 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
8859
8860 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
8861 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
8862 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
8863 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
8864 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
8865 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
8866
8867 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
8868 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
8869 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
8870 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
8871
8872 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
8873 listen smtp
8874 mode tcp
8875 bind :25
8876 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02008877 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01008878
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02008879 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
8880 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
8881 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01008882
8883 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
8884
8885
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008886redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8887redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8888redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008889 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
8890 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8891 no | yes | yes | yes
8892
8893 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01008894 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008895
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008896 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008897 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008898 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
8899 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
8900 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008901
8902 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
8903 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
8904 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
8905 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
8906 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008907 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
8908 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
8909 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
8910 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008911
8912 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
8913 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
8914 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
8915 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
8916 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
8917 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008918 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008919 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008920 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
8921 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
8922 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008923
8924 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01008925 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
8926 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
8927 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02008928 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01008929 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
8930 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
8931 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
8932 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008933
8934 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008935 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008936
8937 - "drop-query"
8938 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
8939 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
8940 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
8941 with a location-type redirect.
8942
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01008943 - "append-slash"
8944 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
8945 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
8946 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
8947 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
8948
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008949 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
8950 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
8951 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
8952 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
8953 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
8954 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
8955 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
8956
8957 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
8958 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
8959 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
8960 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
8961 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
8962 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
8963 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008964
8965 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
8966 acl clear dst_port 80
8967 acl secure dst_port 8080
8968 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008969 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01008970 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008971 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
8972
8973 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01008974 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
8975 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
8976 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01008977 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008978
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01008979 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
8980 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
8981 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
8982
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008983 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01008984 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02008985
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008986 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02008987 http-request redirect code 301 location \
8988 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
8989 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01008990
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008991 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02008992
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01008993
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02008994retries <value>
8995 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
8996 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8997 yes | no | yes | yes
8998 Arguments :
8999 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
9000 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
9001 default value is 3.
9002
9003 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
9004 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
9005 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
9006
9007 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009008 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
9009 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02009010
9011 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
9012 server even if a cookie references a different server.
9013
9014 See also : "option redispatch"
9015
9016
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009017retry-on [list of keywords]
Jerome Magnin5ce3c142020-05-13 20:09:57 +02009018 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request.
9019 This setting is only valid when "mode" is set to http and is silently ignored
9020 otherwise.
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009021 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9022 yes | no | yes | yes
9023 Arguments :
9024 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
9025 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
9026 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
9027 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
9028
9029 none never retry
9030
9031 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
9032 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
9033
9034 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
9035 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
9036 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
9037 request timeout on the server side, poor network
9038 condition, or a server crash or restart while
9039 processing the request.
9040
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +02009041 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
9042 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
9043 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
9044 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
9045 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
9046 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
9047 overflow attack for example).
9048
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009049 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
9050 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
9051 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
9052 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
9053 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
9054 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
9055 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
9056 amplify denial of service attacks.
9057
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +02009058 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
9059 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
9060 considered to be safe to retry.
9061
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009062 <status> any HTTP status code among "404" (Not Found), "408"
9063 (Request Timeout), "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server
9064 Error), "501" (Not Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway),
9065 "503" (Service Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
9066
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +02009067 all-retryable-errors
9068 retry request for any error that are considered
9069 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
9070 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
9071 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
9072
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009073 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
9074 not cumulative.
9075
9076 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
9077 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
9078 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
9079 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
9080
9081 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
9082 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
9083 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
9084 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
9085 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
9086 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
9087 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
9088 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
9089 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
9090 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
9091 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
9092 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
9093
9094 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
9095 should not use this directive.
9096
9097 The default is "conn-failure".
9098
9099 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
9100
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01009101server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009102 Declare a server in a backend
9103 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9104 no | no | yes | yes
9105 Arguments :
9106 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009107 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05009108 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009109
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01009110 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
9111 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
9112 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
9113 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02009114 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
9115 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
9116 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
9117 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
9118 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009119 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
9120 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
9121 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
9122 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
9123 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
9124 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
9125 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02009126 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02009127 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
9128 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
9129 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
9130 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
9131 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
9132 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02009133 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
9134 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01009135 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
9136 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009137
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009138 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009139 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
9140 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
9141 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
9142 adding this value to the client's port.
9143
9144 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
9145 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009146 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009147
9148 Examples :
9149 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
9150 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009151 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02009152 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
9153 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
9154 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009155
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02009156 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
9157 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
9158 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
9159 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
9160 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
9161
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05009162 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
9163 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009164
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02009165server-state-file-name [<file>]
9166 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
9167 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
9168 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
9169 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
9170 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
9171 global directive "server-state-file-base".
9172
9173 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
9174 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
9175
9176 global
9177 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
9178
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +01009179 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02009180 load-server-state-from-file
9181
9182 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
9183 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009184
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02009185server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
9186 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
9187 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
9188 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9189 no | no | yes | yes
9190
9191 Arguments:
9192 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
9193
9194 <num | range>
9195 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
9196 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
9197 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
9198 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
9199
9200 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
9201
9202 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
9203
9204 <params*>
9205 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
9206 keyword.
9207
9208 Examples:
9209 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
9210 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
9211 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
9212
9213 # or
9214 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
9215
9216 # would be equivalent to:
9217 server srv1 google.com:80 check
9218 server srv2 google.com:80 check
9219 server srv3 google.com:80 check
9220
9221
9222
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009223source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009224source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01009225source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009226 Set the source address for outgoing connections
9227 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9228 yes | no | yes | yes
9229 Arguments :
9230 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
9231 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009232
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009233 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009234 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
9235 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
9236 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
9237 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
9238 supported prefixes are :
9239 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
9240 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
9241 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02009242 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02009243 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
9244 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009245
9246 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
9247 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02009248 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
9249 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
9250 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009251
9252 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
9253 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
9254 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
9255 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
9256 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
9257 <addr>.
9258
9259 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
9260 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
9261 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
9262 port.
9263
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009264 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
9265 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
9266 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
9267 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01009268 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009269 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
9270 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
9271 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
9272 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
9273 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
9274 HTTP header.
9275
9276 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
9277 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009278 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009279 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
9280 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
9281 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
9282 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
9283 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
9284 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
9285 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
9286
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01009287 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
9288 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
9289 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
9290 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
9291 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
9292 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
9293
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009294 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
9295 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
9296 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
9297 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
9298
9299 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
9300 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
9301 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
9302 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
9303 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
9304 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
9305
9306 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
9307 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
9308 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
9309 there are two methods :
9310
9311 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
9312 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
9313 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
9314 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
9315 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
9316 of the client ranges may be used.
9317
9318 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
9319 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
9320 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
9321 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
9322 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
9323 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
9324 same session.
9325
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009326 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
9327 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
9328 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009329 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009330
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02009331 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
9332
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009333 Examples :
9334 backend private
9335 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
9336 source 192.168.1.200
9337
9338 backend transparent_ssl1
9339 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
9340 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
9341
9342 backend transparent_ssl2
9343 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
9344 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
9345 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
9346
9347 backend transparent_ssl3
9348 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
9349 # is more conntrack-friendly.
9350 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
9351
9352 backend transparent_smtp
9353 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
9354 # with Tproxy version 4.
9355 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
9356
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02009357 backend transparent_http
9358 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
9359 # proxy.
9360 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
9361
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009362 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009363 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
9364
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009365
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009366stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
9367 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
9368 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009369 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009370
9371 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
9372 matched.
9373
9374 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
9375 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
9376
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009377 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9378 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009379 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009380
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01009381 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
9382 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
9383 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
9384 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009385
9386 Example :
9387 # statistics admin level only for localhost
9388 backend stats_localhost
9389 stats enable
9390 stats admin if LOCALHOST
9391
9392 Example :
9393 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
9394 backend stats_auth
9395 stats enable
9396 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
9397 stats admin if TRUE
9398
9399 Example :
9400 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
9401 userlist stats-auth
9402 group admin users admin
9403 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
9404 group readonly users haproxy
9405 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
9406
9407 backend stats_auth
9408 stats enable
9409 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
9410 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
9411 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
9412 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
9413
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009414 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
9415 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
9416 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02009417
9418
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009419stats auth <user>:<passwd>
9420 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
9421 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009422 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009423 Arguments :
9424 <user> is a user name to grant access to
9425
9426 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
9427
9428 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
9429 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
9430 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
9431 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
9432 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
9433 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
9434
9435 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
9436 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
9437 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02009438 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009439
9440 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
9441 report using "stats scope".
9442
9443 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9444 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9445 unobvious parameters.
9446
9447 Example :
9448 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9449 backend public_www
9450 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9451 stats enable
9452 stats hide-version
9453 stats scope .
9454 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009455 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009456 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9457 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9458
9459 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9460 backend private_monitoring
9461 stats enable
9462 stats uri /admin?stats
9463 stats refresh 5s
9464
9465 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
9466
9467
9468stats enable
9469 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
9470 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009471 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009472 Arguments : none
9473
9474 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
9475 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
9476 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
9477 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
9478 - stats auth : no authentication
9479 - stats scope : no restriction
9480
9481 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9482 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9483 unobvious parameters.
9484
9485 Example :
9486 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9487 backend public_www
9488 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9489 stats enable
9490 stats hide-version
9491 stats scope .
9492 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009493 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009494 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9495 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9496
9497 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9498 backend private_monitoring
9499 stats enable
9500 stats uri /admin?stats
9501 stats refresh 5s
9502
9503 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9504
9505
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009506stats hide-version
9507 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009508 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009509 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009510 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009511
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009512 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
9513 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
9514 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
9515 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
9516 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
9517 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009518
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02009519 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9520 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9521 unobvious parameters.
9522
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009523 Example :
9524 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9525 backend public_www
9526 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02009527 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009528 stats hide-version
9529 stats scope .
9530 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009531 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009532 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9533 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009534
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009535 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9536 backend private_monitoring
9537 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009538 stats uri /admin?stats
9539 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01009540
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009541 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02009542
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01009543
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02009544stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
9545 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
9546 Access control for statistics
9547
9548 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9549 no | no | yes | yes
9550
9551 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
9552 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
9553 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
9554 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
9555 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
9556 should be asked to enter a username and password.
9557
9558 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
9559 instance.
9560
9561 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
9562 about ACL usage.
9563
9564
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009565stats realm <realm>
9566 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
9567 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009568 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009569 Arguments :
9570 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
9571 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
9572 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
9573
9574 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
9575 using a backslash ('\').
9576
9577 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
9578 only related to authentication.
9579
9580 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9581 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9582 unobvious parameters.
9583
9584 Example :
9585 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9586 backend public_www
9587 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9588 stats enable
9589 stats hide-version
9590 stats scope .
9591 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009592 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009593 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9594 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9595
9596 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9597 backend private_monitoring
9598 stats enable
9599 stats uri /admin?stats
9600 stats refresh 5s
9601
9602 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
9603
9604
9605stats refresh <delay>
9606 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
9607 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009608 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009609 Arguments :
9610 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
9611 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
9612 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
9613 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
9614 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
9615 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
9616
9617 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
9618 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
9619 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
9620 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
9621
9622 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9623 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9624 unobvious parameters.
9625
9626 Example :
9627 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9628 backend public_www
9629 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9630 stats enable
9631 stats hide-version
9632 stats scope .
9633 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009634 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009635 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9636 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9637
9638 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9639 backend private_monitoring
9640 stats enable
9641 stats uri /admin?stats
9642 stats refresh 5s
9643
9644 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9645
9646
9647stats scope { <name> | "." }
9648 Enable statistics and limit access scope
9649 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009650 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009651 Arguments :
9652 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
9653 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
9654 section in which the statement appears.
9655
9656 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
9657 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
9658 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
9659 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
9660 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
9661 exists.
9662
9663 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9664 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9665 unobvious parameters.
9666
9667 Example :
9668 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9669 backend public_www
9670 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9671 stats enable
9672 stats hide-version
9673 stats scope .
9674 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009675 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009676 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9677 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9678
9679 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9680 backend private_monitoring
9681 stats enable
9682 stats uri /admin?stats
9683 stats refresh 5s
9684
9685 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
9686
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009687
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009688stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009689 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
9690 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009691 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009692
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02009693 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009694 description from global section is automatically used instead.
9695
9696 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
9697 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
9698
9699 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9700 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009701 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009702
9703 Example :
9704 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9705 backend private_monitoring
9706 stats enable
9707 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
9708 stats uri /admin?stats
9709 stats refresh 5s
9710
9711 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
9712 global section.
9713
9714
9715stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009716 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
9717 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9718 yes | yes | yes | yes
9719 Arguments : none
9720
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009721 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009722 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
9723 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
9724 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
9725 - IP (socket, server)
9726 - cookie (backend, server)
9727
9728 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9729 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009730 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009731
9732 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
9733
9734
9735stats show-node [ <name> ]
9736 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
9737 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009738 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009739 Arguments:
9740 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
9741 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
9742
9743 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
9744 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009745 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009746
9747 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9748 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9749 unobvious parameters.
9750
9751 Example:
9752 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9753 backend private_monitoring
9754 stats enable
9755 stats show-node Europe-1
9756 stats uri /admin?stats
9757 stats refresh 5s
9758
9759 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
9760 section.
9761
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009762
9763stats uri <prefix>
9764 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
9765 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02009766 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009767 Arguments :
9768 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
9769 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
9770 query string.
9771
9772 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
9773 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
9774 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
9775 possible to reach it in the application.
9776
9777 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009778 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009779 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
9780 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
9781 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
9782 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
9783
9784 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
9785 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
9786 an address or a port to statistics only.
9787
9788 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
9789 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
9790 unobvious parameters.
9791
9792 Example :
9793 # public access (limited to this backend only)
9794 backend public_www
9795 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
9796 stats enable
9797 stats hide-version
9798 stats scope .
9799 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009800 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009801 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
9802 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
9803
9804 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
9805 backend private_monitoring
9806 stats enable
9807 stats uri /admin?stats
9808 stats refresh 5s
9809
9810 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
9811
9812
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009813stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
9814 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009815 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01009816 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009817
9818 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009819 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009820 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009821 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009822 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
9823
9824 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9825 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9826 the "stick-table" statement.
9827
9828 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
9829 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
9830 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
9831 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
9832 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
9833
9834 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9835 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
9836 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
9837 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
9838 transformation rules.
9839
9840 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9841 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9842 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9843 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9844 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9845 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9846 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9847
9848 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
9849 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
9850 ACL based conditions.
9851
9852 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
9853 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
9854 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
9855 matches can be used as fallbacks.
9856
9857 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
9858 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
9859 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
9860 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
9861
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009862 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9863 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009864 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009865
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009866 Example :
9867 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
9868 # last 30 minutes
9869 backend pop
9870 mode tcp
9871 balance roundrobin
9872 stick store-request src
9873 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9874 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
9875 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
9876
9877 backend smtp
9878 mode tcp
9879 balance roundrobin
9880 stick match src table pop
9881 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
9882 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
9883
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009884 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009885 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009886
9887
9888stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
9889 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
9890 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9891 no | no | yes | yes
9892
9893 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
9894 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
9895 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
9896 for writing more maintainable configurations.
9897
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009898 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9899 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009900 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009901
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009902 Examples :
9903 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01009904 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009905
9906 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
9907 stick match src table pop if !localhost
9908 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
9909
9910
9911 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
9912 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
9913 backend http
9914 mode http
9915 balance roundrobin
9916 stick on src table https
9917 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
9918 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
9919 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
9920
9921 backend https
9922 mode tcp
9923 balance roundrobin
9924 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
9925 stick on src
9926 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
9927 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
9928
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009929 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009930
9931
9932stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
9933 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
9934 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9935 no | no | yes | yes
9936
9937 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009938 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009939 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009940 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009941 server is selected.
9942
9943 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
9944 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
9945 the "stick-table" statement.
9946
9947 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
9948 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
9949 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
9950 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
9951 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
9952 address.
9953
9954 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
9955 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
9956 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
9957 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
9958 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
9959 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
9960 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
9961 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
9962 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
9963 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
9964
9965 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
9966 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
9967 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
9968 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
9969 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
9970 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
9971 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
9972
9973 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
9974 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
9975 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
9976 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
9977
9978 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
9979 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
9980 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
9981 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
9982 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
9983 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01009984 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
9985 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
9986 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
9987 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
9988 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
9989 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009990
9991 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
9992 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
9993 the request.
9994
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009995 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
9996 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009997 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01009998
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01009999 Example :
10000 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
10001 # last 30 minutes
10002 backend pop
10003 mode tcp
10004 balance roundrobin
10005 stick store-request src
10006 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10007 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
10008 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
10009
10010 backend smtp
10011 mode tcp
10012 balance roundrobin
10013 stick match src table pop
10014 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
10015 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
10016
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010017 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010018 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010019
10020
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010021stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020010022 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
10023 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +080010024 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010025 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020010026 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010027
10028 Arguments :
10029 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
10030 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
10031 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
10032 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
10033
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +010010034 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
10035 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
10036 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
10037 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
10038
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010039 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
10040 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
10041 instance.
10042
10043 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
10044 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
10045 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
10046 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
10047 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
10048 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010049 to 32 characters.
10050
10051 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
10052 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
10053 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010054 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010055 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
10056 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010057
10058 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010059 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
10060 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010061 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
10062 increase.
10063
10064 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010065 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
10066 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
10067 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010068
10069 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
10070 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
10071 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
10072 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010073 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010074 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
10075 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
10076 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
10077 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
10078 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
10079 parameter (see below).
10080
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020010081 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
10082 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
10083 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
10084 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
10085 soft restart.
10086
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +020010087 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
10088 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010089
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010090 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
10091 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
10092 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
10093 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +030010094 section 2.4 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010095 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010096 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
10097 if not expiration delay is specified.
10098
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020010099 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
10100 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
10101 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
10102 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010103 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
10104 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
10105 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
10106 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
10107 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
10108 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
10109 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
10110 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
10111 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
10112 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
10113 types and their arguments.
10114
10115 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
10116 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
10117 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
10118 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
10119
10120 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
10121 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
10122 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010123 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010124
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010125 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
10126 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
10127 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010128 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010129 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010130 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020010131
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010132 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
10133 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
10134 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
10135 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
10136
10137 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
10138 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
10139 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
10140 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
10141 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
10142 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
10143
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010144 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
10145 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
10146 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
10147 they were received.
10148
10149 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10150 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
10151 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
10152 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
10153 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
10154
10155 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10156 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10157 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10158 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
10159 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10160
10161 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
10162 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
10163 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
10164
10165 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10166 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10167 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10168 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
10169 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10170
10171 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10172 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
10173 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
10174 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
10175 the client side.
10176
10177 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10178 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10179 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10180 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
10181 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
10182 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
10183 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
10184
10185 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
10186 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
10187 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
10188 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
10189 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
10190 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010191 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010192
10193 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10194 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10195 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10196 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
10197 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
10198 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
10199
10200 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010201 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010202 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
10203 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
10204
10205 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
10206 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10207 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10208 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
10209 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
10210 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
10211 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
10212 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
10213 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
10214 recommended for better fairness.
10215
10216 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010217 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010218 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
10219 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
10220
10221 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
10222 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
10223 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
10224 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
10225 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
10226 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
10227 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
10228 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
10229 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
10230 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020010231
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020010232 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
10233 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010234 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
10235 reference it.
10236
10237 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
10238 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +010010239 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
10240 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
10241 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010242
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010243 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
10244 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
10245 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
10246 something that can be ignored.
10247
10248 Example:
10249 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
10250 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
10251 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
10252 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
10253
Jarno Huuskonene0ee0be2017-07-04 10:35:12 +030010254 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.4
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +010010255 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010256
10257
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010258stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +010010259 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010260 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10261 no | no | yes | yes
10262
10263 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010264 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010265 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010266 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010267 server is selected.
10268
10269 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10270 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10271 the "stick-table" statement.
10272
10273 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
10274 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
10275 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
10276 when the response is a SSL server hello.
10277
10278 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10279 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
10280 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
10281 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
10282 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
10283 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010284 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010285 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
10286 rules.
10287
10288 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10289 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10290 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10291 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10292 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10293 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10294 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10295
10296 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
10297 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
10298 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
10299 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
10300
10301 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
10302 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
10303 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
10304 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
10305 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
10306 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010010307 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
10308 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
10309 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
10310 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
10311 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
10312 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
10313 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
10314 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
10315 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010316
10317 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
10318
10319 Example :
10320 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
10321 backend https
10322 mode tcp
10323 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010324 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010325 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010326
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010327 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
10328 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
10329
10330 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
10331 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
10332 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
10333
10334 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
10335 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010336
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010337 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
10338 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
10339 # at offset 44.
10340
10341 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
10342 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
10343
10344 # Learn on response if server hello.
10345 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010346
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020010347 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
10348 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
10349
10350 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
10351 extraction.
10352
10353
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010354tcp-check comment <string>
10355 Defines a comment for the following the tcp-check rule, reported in logs if
10356 it fails.
10357 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10358 yes | no | yes | yes
10359
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010360 Arguments :
10361 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following tcp-check
10362 rule fails.
10363
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010364 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
10365 user-friendly error reporting.
10366
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010367 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send" and
10368 "tcp-check expect".
10369
10370
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010371tcp-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy] [via-socks4]
10372 [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020010373 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010374 Opens a new connection
10375 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010376 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010377
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010378 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010379 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
10380
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020010381 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Christopher Fauletbb591a12020-04-01 16:52:17 +020010382 checks. The server options are used only if not redifined.
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020010383
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020010384 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020010385 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
10386 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020010387 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020010388
10389 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010390
10391 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
10392
Christopher Faulet085426a2020-03-30 13:07:02 +020010393 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
10394
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010395 ssl opens a ciphered connection
10396
Christopher Faulet79b31d42020-03-30 13:00:05 +020010397 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
10398
Christopher Faulet98572322020-03-30 13:16:44 +020010399 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
10400 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
10401 for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
10402 If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
10403
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020010404 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
10405 It must be a TCP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
10406 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
10407 haproxy -vv.
10408
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020010409 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010410
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010411 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
10412 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
10413 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
10414
10415 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
10416 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
10417 of the sequence.
10418
10419 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
10420 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
10421 do.
10422
10423 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
10424 unset-var or comment rules.
10425
10426 Examples :
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010427 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
10428 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
10429 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
10430 option tcp-check
10431 tcp-check connect
10432 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
10433 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
10434 tcp-check send \r\n
10435 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
10436 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
10437 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
10438 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
10439 tcp-check send \r\n
10440 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
10441 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
10442
10443 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
10444 option tcp-check
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010445 tcp-check connect port 110 linger
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010446 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
10447 tcp-check connect port 143
10448 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
10449 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
10450
10451 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
10452
10453
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010454tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020010455 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020010456 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010457 [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010458 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010459 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010460 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010461
10462 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010463 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
10464
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010465 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
10466 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
10467 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
10468 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
10469 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
10470 incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
10471 minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
10472 This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
10473 does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
10474 the evaluation result is always conclusive.
10475
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010476 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010477 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
10478 "rbinary".
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010479 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
10480 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
10481 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
10482
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020010483 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
10484 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
10485 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020010486 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
10487 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
10488 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, for
10489 example 404 with disable-on-404
10490 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
10491 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020010492 By default "L7OK" is used.
10493
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010494 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
10495 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020010496 "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are supported :
10497 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
10498 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
10499 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
10500 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
10501 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010502
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020010503 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010504 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020010505 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
10506 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
10507 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
10508 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020010509 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
10510
Christopher Fauletbe52b4d2020-04-01 16:30:22 +020010511 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
10512 informational message reported in logs if the expect
10513 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
10514 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
10515
10516 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
10517 informational message reported in logs if an error
10518 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
10519 log-format string.
10520
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020010521 status-code <expr> is optional and can be used to set the check status code
10522 reported in logs, on success or on error. <expr> is a
10523 standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10524 followed by some converters.
10525
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010526 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
10527 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
10528 with the usual backslash ('\').
10529 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010530 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010531 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
10532 used upper or lower case.
10533
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010534 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
10535
10536 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
10537 A health check response will be considered valid if the
10538 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
10539 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
10540 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
10541 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
10542 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
10543 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
10544
10545 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
10546 A health check response will be considered valid if the
10547 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
10548 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
10549 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
10550 expression.
10551
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020010552 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the response's buffer.
10553 A health check response will be considered valid if the
10554 response's buffer contains the string resulting of the
10555 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
10556 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
10557 considered invalid if the buffer contains the string.
10558
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010559 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
10560 in the response buffer. A health check response will
10561 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
10562 this exact hexadecimal string.
10563 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
10564
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010010565 rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
10566 "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
10567 into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
10568 allows using all regex engines to match any binary
10569 content. The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
10570 size of the original response. As such, the expected
10571 pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
10572 size.
10573
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020010574 binary-lf <hexfmt> : test a log-format string in its hexadecimal form
10575 match in the response's buffer. A health check response
10576 will be considered valid if the response's buffer
10577 contains the hexadecimal string resulting of the
10578 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format
10579 rules. If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
10580 considered invalid if the buffer contains the
10581 hexadecimal string. The hexadecimal string is converted
10582 in a binary string before matching the response's
10583 buffer.
10584
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010585 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
10586 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
10587 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
10588 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
10589 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
10590 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
10591 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
10592 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
10593 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
10594 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
10595 the null character.
10596
10597 Examples :
10598 # perform a POP check
10599 option tcp-check
10600 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
10601
10602 # perform an IMAP check
10603 option tcp-check
10604 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
10605
10606 # look for the redis master server
10607 option tcp-check
10608 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020010609 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010610 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
10611 tcp-check expect string role:master
10612 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
10613 tcp-check expect string +OK
10614
10615
10616 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
10617 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
10618
10619
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010620tcp-check send <data> [comment <msg>]
10621tcp-check send-lf <fmt> [comment <msg>]
10622 Specify a string or a log-format string to be sent as a question during a
10623 generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010624 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010625 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010626
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010627 Arguments :
10628 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
10629
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010630 <data> is the string that will be sent during a generic health
10631 check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020010632
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010633 <fmt> is the log-format string that will be sent, once evaluated,
10634 during a generic health check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010635
10636 Examples :
10637 # look for the redis master server
10638 option tcp-check
10639 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
10640 tcp-check expect string role:master
10641
10642 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
10643 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
10644
10645
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010646tcp-check send-binary <hexstring> [comment <msg>]
10647tcp-check send-binary-lf <hexfmt> [comment <msg>]
10648 Specify an hex digits string or an hex digits log-format string to be sent as
10649 a binary question during a raw tcp health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010650 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010651 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010652
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020010653 Arguments :
10654 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010655
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010656 <hexstring> is the hexadecimal string that will be send, once converted
10657 to binary, during a generic health check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020010658
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020010659 <hexfmt> is the hexadecimal log-format string that will be send, once
10660 evaluated and converted to binary, during a generic health
10661 check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020010662
10663 Examples :
10664 # redis check in binary
10665 option tcp-check
10666 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
10667 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
10668
10669
10670 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
10671 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
10672
10673
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010674tcp-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010675 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010676 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010677 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010678
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010679 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010680 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
10681 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
10682 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
10683 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
10684 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
10685 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
10686 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
10687 and '-'.
10688
10689 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
10690
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010691 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010692 tcp-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
10693
10694
10695tcp-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010696 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010697 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020010698 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010699
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010700 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010701 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
10702 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
10703 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
10704 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
10705 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
10706 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
10707 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
10708 and '-'.
10709
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010710 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010711 tcp-check unset-var(check.port)
10712
10713
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010714tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10715 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020010716 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10717 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010718 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010719 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10720 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020010721
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010722 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010723
10724 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
10725 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010726 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
10727 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
10728 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
10729 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
10730 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
10731 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010732
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010733 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
10734 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
10735 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
10736 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010737
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020010738 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010739 - accept :
10740 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10741 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10742 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010743
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010744 - reject :
10745 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
10746 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
10747 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
10748 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
10749 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
10750 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
10751 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
10752 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
10753 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
10754 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
10755 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010756 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010757
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010758 - expect-proxy layer4 :
10759 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
10760 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
10761 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
10762 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
10763 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
10764 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
10765 hosts.
10766
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010010767 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
10768 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
10769 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
10770 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
10771 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
10772 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
10773 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
10774 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
10775
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010776 - capture <sample> len <length> :
10777 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
10778 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
10779 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
10780 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
10781 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
10782 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
10783 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
10784 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020010785 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
10786 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010787
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010788 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010789 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020010790 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
10791 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
10792 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050010793 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020010794 and (MAX_SESS_STCKTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
10795 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
10796 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
10797 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
10798 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
10799 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
10800 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
10801 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010802
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010803 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010804 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020010805 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010806 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010807 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
10808 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
10809 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010810
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010811 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
10812 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
10813 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
10814 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010815
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010816 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
10817 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
10818 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
10819 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
10820 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010010821 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
10822 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
10823 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
10824 layer7 information is extracted.
10825
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010826 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
10827 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
10828 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
10829 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
10830 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010831
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020010832 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
10833 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
10834 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
10835 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
10836
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010010837 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
10838 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
10839 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
10840 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
10841
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010010842 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
10843 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
10844 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
10845 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
10846 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010847
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010848 - set-src <expr> :
10849 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
10850 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
10851 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020010852 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010853
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020010854 Arguments:
10855 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10856 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010857
10858 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010859 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
10860
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010861 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
10862 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020010863
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010864 - set-src-port <expr> :
10865 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
10866 expression.
10867
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020010868 Arguments:
10869 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10870 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010871
10872 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010873 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
10874
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010875 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
10876 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
10877 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020010878
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020010879 - set-dst <expr> :
10880 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
10881 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
10882 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
10883 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
10884 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
10885
10886 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10887 followed by some converters.
10888
10889 Example:
10890
10891 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
10892 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
10893
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010894 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
10895 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
10896
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020010897 - set-dst-port <expr> :
10898 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
10899 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
10900 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
10901
10902
10903 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
10904 followed by some converters.
10905
10906 Example:
10907
10908 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
10909
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020010910 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
10911 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
10912 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
10913
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010914 - "silent-drop" :
10915 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010916 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010917 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
10918 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
10919 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
10920 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
10921 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010922 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
10923 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010924 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
10925 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010926 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020010927 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
10928 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
10929 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
10930 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
10931
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010932 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
10933 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
10934 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010935
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010936 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
10937 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
10938 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010939
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010940 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010941 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010942 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010943
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010944 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
10945 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
10946 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010947
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010948 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020010949 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
10950 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010951
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010952 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
10953
10954 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
10955
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010956 See section 7 about ACL usage.
10957
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020010958 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020010959
10960
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010961tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10962 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010963 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020010964 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010965 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020010966 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
10967 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010968
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010969 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010970
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010971 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010972 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
10973 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
10974 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
10975 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010976
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010977 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
10978 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
10979 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
10980 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010981 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
10982 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
10983 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
10984 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
10985 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
10986 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010987 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010010988 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010989
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020010990 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
10991 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
10992 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
10993 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020010994
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020010995 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010996 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010010997 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020010998 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
10999 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040011000 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011001 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011002 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011003 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011004 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020011005 - set-dst <expr>
11006 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011007 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011008 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011009 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011010 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010011011 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011012
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011013 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
11014 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010011015 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
11016 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011017
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011018 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
11019 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
11020 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
11021 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
11022 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
11023 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011024
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011025 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011026 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11027 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011028
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011029 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020011030 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
11031 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
11032 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
11033 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011034 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
11035 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
11036 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011037
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011038 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020011039 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
11040 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
11041 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011042
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020011043 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
11044 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
11045
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011046 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011047 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
11048 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011049
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011050 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
11051 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010011052 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011053 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
11054 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011055 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011056 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011057 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011058 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
11059 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011060 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010011061 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
11062 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011063
11064 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11065 followed by some converters.
11066
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011067 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
11068 <var-name>.
11069
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040011070 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
11071 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
11072 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
11073 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
11074 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
11075
11076 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
11077 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
11078 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
11079 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
11080 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
11081 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
11082 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
11083 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
11084 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
11085 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
11086 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
11087
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020011088 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
11089 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
11090 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
11091 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
11092 the SPOE agent name must be used.
11093
11094 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
11095
11096 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
11097
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010011098 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
11099 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
11100 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
11101 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
11102 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
11103 evaluated.
11104
11105 Example:
11106 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
11107
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011108 Example:
11109
11110 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011111 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011112
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011113 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011114 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
11115 # and reject everything else.
11116 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
11117 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020011118 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011119 tcp-request content reject
11120
11121 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011122 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
11123 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
11124 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011125 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011126
11127 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
11128 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
11129 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011130 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011131 tcp-request content reject
11132
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011133 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011134 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011135 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020011136 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011137 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
11138 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011139
11140 Example:
11141 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
11142 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020011143 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011144
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011145 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011146 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011147
11148 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011149 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011150 # protecting all our sites
11151 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011152 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
11153 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011154 ...
11155 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
11156
11157 backend http_dynamic
11158 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011159 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011160 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011161 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030011162 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011163 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011164 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011165
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011166 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011167
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030011168 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
11169 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011170
11171
11172tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
11173 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
11174 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020011175 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011176 Arguments :
11177 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11178 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11179 as explained at the top of this document.
11180
11181 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
11182 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
11183 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
11184 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
11185 data for at most the specified amount of time.
11186
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020011187 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
11188 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
11189 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
11190 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
11191
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011192 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
11193 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011194 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011195 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010011196 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
11197 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
11198 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
11199 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011200
11201 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
11202 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
11203 it pass through unaffected.
11204
11205 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
11206 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
11207 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011208 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011209 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
11210 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020011211 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
11212 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
11213 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011214
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020011215 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011216 "timeout client".
11217
11218
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011219tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11220 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
11221 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11222 no | no | yes | yes
11223 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011224 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11225 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011226
11227 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
11228
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011229 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011230 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
11231 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020011232 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
11233 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011234
11235 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
11236
11237 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
11238 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
11239 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
11240 inserted.
11241
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011242 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011243 - accept :
11244 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11245 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11246 the rules evaluation.
11247
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020011248 - close :
11249 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
11250 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
11251 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
11252 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
11253 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
11254 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011255 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020011256 protocols.
11257
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011258 - reject :
11259 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11260 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011261 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011262
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011263 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
11264 Sets a variable.
11265
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011266 - unset-var(<var-name>)
11267 Unsets a variable.
11268
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011269 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
11270 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
11271 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
11272 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
11273
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011274 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
11275 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
11276 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
11277 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
11278
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011279 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
11280 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
11281 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
11282 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
11283 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011284
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011285 - "silent-drop" :
11286 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011287 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011288 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
11289 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
11290 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
11291 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
11292 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011293 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
11294 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011295 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
11296 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011297 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011298 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
11299 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
11300 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
11301 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
11302
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020011303 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
11304 Send a group of SPOE messages.
11305
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011306 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
11307 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11308 for changing the default action to a reject.
11309
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011310 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
11311 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
11312 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
11313 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011314 period.
11315
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011316 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
11317 declared inline.
11318
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011319 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
11320 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010011321 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011322 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
11323 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011324 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011325 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011326 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011327 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
11328 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011329 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010011330 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
11331 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011332
11333 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11334 followed by some converters.
11335
11336 Example:
11337
11338 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
11339
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011340 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
11341 <var-name>.
11342
11343 Example:
11344
11345 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
11346
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020011347 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
11348 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
11349 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
11350 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
11351 the SPOE agent name must be used.
11352
11353 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
11354
11355 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
11356
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011357 See section 7 about ACL usage.
11358
11359 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
11360
11361
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011362tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11363 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
11364 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11365 no | yes | yes | no
11366 Arguments :
11367 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11368 below.
11369
11370 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
11371
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011372 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011373 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
11374 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
11375 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
11376 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
11377 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
11378 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
11379 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011380 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011381 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
11382 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
11383 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
11384 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
11385 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
11386 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
11387 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
11388 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
11389 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
11390 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
11391 instead.
11392
11393 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
11394 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
11395 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
11396 rules which may be inserted.
11397
11398 Several types of actions are supported :
11399 - accept : the request is accepted
11400 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
11401 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
11402 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011403 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011404 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011405 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011406 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011407 - silent-drop
11408
11409 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
11410 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
11411 sections for a complete description.
11412
11413 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
11414 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11415 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
11416
11417 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
11418 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
11419 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
11420 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
11421 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
11422
11423 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
11424 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
11425
11426 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
11427 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
11428 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
11429
11430 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
11431 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
11432 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
11433
11434 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
11435 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
11436 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
11437
11438 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
11439 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
11440 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
11441
11442 See section 7 about ACL usage.
11443
11444 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
11445
11446
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020011447tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
11448 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
11449 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11450 no | no | yes | yes
11451 Arguments :
11452 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11453 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11454 as explained at the top of this document.
11455
11456 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
11457
11458
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011459timeout check <timeout>
11460 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
11461 established.
11462
11463 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11464 yes | no | yes | yes
11465 Arguments:
11466 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11467 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11468 as explained at the top of this document.
11469
11470 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
11471 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011472 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011473 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010011474 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
11475 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
11476 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011477
11478 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
11479 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
11480
11481 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
11482 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010011483 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011484
11485 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11486 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11487 forget about it.
11488
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010011489 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
11490 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011491
11492
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011493timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011494 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
11495 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11496 yes | yes | yes | no
11497 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011498 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011499 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11500 as explained at the top of this document.
11501
11502 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
11503 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
11504 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010011505 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
11506 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
11507 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
11508 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011509 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
11510 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
11511 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010011512 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011513 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011514 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
11515 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011516 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
11517 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011518
11519 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
11520 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11521 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
11522 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011523 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011524 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
11525
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011526 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010011527
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011528 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011529
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011530
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011531timeout client-fin <timeout>
11532 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
11533 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11534 yes | yes | yes | no
11535 Arguments :
11536 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11537 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11538 as explained at the top of this document.
11539
11540 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
11541 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
11542 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
11543 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
11544 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
11545 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
11546 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010011547 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
11548 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
11549 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011550
11551 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
11552 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
11553 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
11554
11555 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
11556
11557
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011558timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011559 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
11560 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11561 yes | no | yes | yes
11562 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011563 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011564 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11565 as explained at the top of this document.
11566
11567 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010011568 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011569 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011570 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010011571 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
11572 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011573
11574 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11575 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11576 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
11577 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011578 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011579 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
11580
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011581 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011582
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011583
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011584timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
11585 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
11586 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11587 yes | yes | yes | yes
11588 Arguments :
11589 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11590 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11591 as explained at the top of this document.
11592
11593 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
11594 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
11595 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
11596 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
11597 once the request has started to present itself.
11598
11599 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
11600 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
11601 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
11602 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
11603 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
11604
11605 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
11606 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
11607 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
11608 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
11609
11610 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
11611 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011612 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011613 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
11614 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020011615 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011616
11617 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
11618 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
11619 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
11620 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
11621
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010011622 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
11623 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010011624 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
11625
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011626 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
11627
11628
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011629timeout http-request <timeout>
11630 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
11631 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020011632 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011633 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011634 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011635 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11636 as explained at the top of this document.
11637
11638 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
11639 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
11640 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
11641 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
11642 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
11643 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
11644 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020011645 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
11646 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
11647 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
11648 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011649 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020011650 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
11651 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011652
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010011653 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
11654 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
11655 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
11656 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
11657 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010011658 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011659
11660 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
11661 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011662 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011663 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
11664 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
11665
11666 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020011667 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
11668 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
11669 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011670
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020011671 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010011672 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011673
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011674
11675timeout queue <timeout>
11676 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
11677 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11678 yes | no | yes | yes
11679 Arguments :
11680 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11681 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11682 as explained at the top of this document.
11683
11684 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
11685 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
11686 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
11687 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
11688 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
11689
11690 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
11691 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
11692 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
11693 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
11694
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011695 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011696
11697
11698timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011699 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
11700 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11701 yes | no | yes | yes
11702 Arguments :
11703 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11704 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11705 as explained at the top of this document.
11706
11707 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
11708 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
11709 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
11710 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
11711 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
11712 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
11713 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
11714
11715 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
11716 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
11717 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
11718 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
11719 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010011720 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011721 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011722 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
11723 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011724 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
11725 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011726
11727 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11728 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11729 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
11730 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011731 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011732 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
11733
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011734 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011735
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011736
11737timeout server-fin <timeout>
11738 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
11739 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11740 yes | no | yes | yes
11741 Arguments :
11742 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11743 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11744 as explained at the top of this document.
11745
11746 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
11747 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
11748 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
11749 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
11750 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
11751 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
11752 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
11753 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
11754 situations, it should not be needed.
11755
11756 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11757 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
11758 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
11759
11760 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
11761
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011762
11763timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011764 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011765 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11766 yes | yes | yes | yes
11767 Arguments :
11768 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
11769 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11770 as explained at the top of this document.
11771
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020011772 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
11773 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
11774 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011775
11776 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
11777 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
11778 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
11779 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011780 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011781
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020011782 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011783
11784
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011785timeout tunnel <timeout>
11786 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
11787 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11788 yes | no | yes | yes
11789 Arguments :
11790 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
11791 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
11792 as explained at the top of this document.
11793
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011794 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011795 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
11796 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
11797 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011798 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
11799 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011800 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
11801 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
11802 specified.
11803
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011804 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
11805 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
11806 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
11807 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
11808 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
11809 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
11810 state.
11811
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011812 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
11813 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
11814 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
11815 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011816 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011817
11818 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
11819 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
11820 forget about it.
11821
11822 Example :
11823 defaults http
11824 option http-server-close
11825 timeout connect 5s
11826 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011827 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011828 timeout server 30s
11829 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
11830
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020011831 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020011832
11833
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011834transparent (deprecated)
11835 Enable client-side transparent proxying
11836 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010011837 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011838 Arguments : none
11839
11840 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
11841 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
11842 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
11843 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
11844 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
11845 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
11846 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
11847 appropriate server.
11848
11849 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
11850
11851 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
11852 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
11853
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011854 See also: "option transparent"
11855
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011856unique-id-format <string>
11857 Generate a unique ID for each request.
11858 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11859 yes | yes | yes | no
11860 Arguments :
11861 <string> is a log-format string.
11862
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011863 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
11864 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
11865 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
11866 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011867
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011868 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
11869 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
11870 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
11871 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
11872 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
11873 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
11874 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
11875 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011876
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011877 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
11878 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011879
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011880 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011881
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050011882 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011883
11884 will generate:
11885
11886 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
11887
11888 See also: "unique-id-header"
11889
11890unique-id-header <name>
11891 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
11892 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11893 yes | yes | yes | no
11894 Arguments :
11895 <name> is the name of the header.
11896
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011897 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
11898 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011899
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011900 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011901
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050011902 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010011903 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
11904
11905 will generate:
11906
11907 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
11908
11909 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011910
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020011911use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011912 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011913 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11914 no | yes | yes | no
11915 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011916 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
11917 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011918
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020011919 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
11920 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011921
11922 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
11923 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
11924 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011925 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011926 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020011927 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
11928 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011929
11930 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
11931 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
11932 assign the backend.
11933
11934 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
11935 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
11936 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
11937 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
11938 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
11939 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
11940
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020011941 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011942 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020011943 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
11944 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
11945 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
11946
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011947 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
11948 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
11949 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
11950 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
11951 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
11952 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
11953 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
11954 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
11955 cannot be forced from the request.
11956
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011957 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010011958 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
11959 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
11960
11961 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
11962 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011963
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020011964use-fcgi-app <name>
11965 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
11966 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11967 no | no | yes | yes
11968 Arguments :
11969 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
11970
11971 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010011972
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011973use-server <server> if <condition>
11974use-server <server> unless <condition>
11975 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
11976 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11977 no | no | yes | yes
11978 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020011979 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
11980 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020011981
11982 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
11983
11984 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
11985 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
11986 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
11987
11988 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
11989 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
11990 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
11991 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
11992 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
11993 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
11994 matches will assign the server.
11995
11996 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
11997 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
11998 with the next rules until one matches.
11999
12000 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
12001 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
12002 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
12003 according to other persistence mechanisms.
12004
12005 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
12006 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
12007 stripped.
12008
12009 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
12010 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
12011 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
12012 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
12013
12014 Example :
12015 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
12016 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
12017 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
12018 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
12019 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
12020 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000012021 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012022 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
12023 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
12024
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020012025 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
12026 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
12027 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
12028 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050012029 was conditioned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020012030 and we fall back to load balancing.
12031
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012032 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012033
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012034
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100120355. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012036--------------------------
12037
12038The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
12039depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
12040settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
12041written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
12042described in this section.
12043
12044
120455.1. Bind options
12046-----------------
12047
12048The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
12049as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
12050no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
12051parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
12052while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
12053provided immediately after the setting name.
12054
12055The currently supported settings are the following ones.
12056
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012057accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
12058 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
12059 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
12060 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
12061 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
12062 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
12063 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
12064 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
12065 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
12066 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010012067 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
12068 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
12069 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012070
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012071accept-proxy
12072 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020012073 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
12074 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012075 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
12076 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
12077 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
12078 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012079 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012080 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
12081 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012082 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
12083 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012084
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020012085allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010012086 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010012087 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012088 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010012089 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
12090 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020012091
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012092alpn <protocols>
12093 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
12094 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
12095 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012096 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012097 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012098 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
12099 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
12100 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
12101 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
12102 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
12103 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
12104 preference, like below :
12105
12106 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012107
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012108backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010012109 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012110 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
12111
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010012112curves <curves>
12113 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
12114 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
12115 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
12116 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
12117 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
12118 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
12119
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020012120ecdhe <named curve>
12121 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010012122 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
12123 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020012124
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020012125ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020012126 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12127 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
12128 client's certificate.
12129
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020012130ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
12131 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
12132 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
12133 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
12134 error is ignored.
12135
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012136ca-sign-file <cafile>
12137 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12138 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
12139 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
12140 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
12141 'generate-certificates' for details.
12142
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000012143ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012144 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
12145 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
12146 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
12147 'generate-certificates' for details.
12148
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010012149ca-verify-file <cafile>
12150 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
12151 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
12152 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
12153 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
12154 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
12155
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012156ciphers <ciphers>
12157 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
12158 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000012159 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012160 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012161 information and recommendations see e.g.
12162 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
12163 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
12164 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
12165
12166ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
12167 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
12168 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
12169 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
12170 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012171 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
12172 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012173
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020012174crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020012175 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12176 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
12177 to verify client's certificate.
12178
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012179crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012180 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12181 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
12182 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
12183 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
12184 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010012185 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
12186 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012187
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010012188 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
12189 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
12190
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012191 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
12192 are loaded.
12193
12194 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010012195 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
12196 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This
12197 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
12198 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
12199 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their
12200 CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*'
12201 is used instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010012202 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012203
12204 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
12205 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
12206 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
12207 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010012208 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
12209 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012210
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020012211 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012212
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012213 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012214 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012215 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
12216 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012217 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
12218 clients).
12219
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020012220 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
12221 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
12222 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
12223 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
12224 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
12225 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
12226 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
12227 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
12228 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
12229 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
12230 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
12231 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
12232 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
12233
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010012234 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
12235 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
12236 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
12237 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
12238 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
12239
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050012240 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
12241 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
12242 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
12243 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012244
12245 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
12246 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
12247 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
12248 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
12249 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
12250 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
12251 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
12252 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
12253 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
12254
12255 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
12256
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050012257 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012258 a cert bundle.
12259
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012260 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012261 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
12262 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
12263 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
12264 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
12265 provide multi-cert support.
12266
12267 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
12268
12269 Filename | CN | SAN
12270 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
12271 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050012272 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012273 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
12274 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
12275
12276 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
12277 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
12278 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
12279 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020012280 suites. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is natively supported,
12281 no need to bundle certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client
12282 support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012283
12284 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
12285 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
12286
12287 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
12288 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
12289 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
12290
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020012291crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012292 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012293 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012294 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000012295 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020012296
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012297crt-list <file>
12298 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012299 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
12300 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012301
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012302 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
12303
William Lallemand5d036392020-06-30 16:11:36 +020012304 sslbindconf supports "allow-0rtt", "alpn", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
12305 "ciphers", "ciphersuites", "crl-file", "curves", "ecdhe", "no-ca-names",
12306 "npn", "verify" configuration. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1
12307 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported. It overrides the
12308 configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012309
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020012310 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
12311 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
12312 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
12313 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
12314 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
12315 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
12316 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
12317 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010012318
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050012319 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020012320 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet84e417d2017-08-16 11:33:17 +020012321 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1 multi-cert is
12322 natively supported, avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can
12323 be declared in a row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050012324
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020012325 Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a hash ('#') will be ignored.
12326
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012327 crt-list file example:
12328 cert1.pem
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020012329 # comment
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010012330 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012331 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010012332 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010012333
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012334defer-accept
12335 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
12336 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
12337 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012338 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012339 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
12340 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
12341 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
12342 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
12343 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
12344 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
12345 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
12346
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020012347expose-fd listeners
12348 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
12349 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020012350 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
12351 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012352 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020012353
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012354force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012355 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012356 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012357 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012358 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012359
12360force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012361 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012362 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012363 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012364
12365force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012366 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012367 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012368 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012369
12370force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012371 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012372 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012373 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012374
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012375force-tlsv13
12376 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
12377 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012378 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012379
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012380generate-certificates
12381 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12382 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
12383 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
12384 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
12385 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
12386 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
12387 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
12388 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
12389 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
12390 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
12391 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
12392
12393 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
12394 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012395 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020012396 certificate is used many times.
12397
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012398gid <gid>
12399 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
12400 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
12401 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
12402 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
12403 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12404
12405group <group>
12406 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
12407 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
12408 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
12409 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
12410 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12411
12412id <id>
12413 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
12414 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
12415 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
12416 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
12417
12418interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010012419 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
12420 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
12421 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
12422 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
12423 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
12424 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010012425 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
12426 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
12427 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
12428 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
12429 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
12430 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012431
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012432level <level>
12433 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
12434 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
12435 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012436 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012437 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
12438 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
12439 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012440 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012441 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012442 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020012443 all counters).
12444
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020012445severity-output <format>
12446 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
12447 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
12448 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
12449 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
12450 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
12451 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
12452 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
12453 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
12454 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
12455 rfc5424 convention.
12456
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012457maxconn <maxconn>
12458 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
12459 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
12460 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
12461 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
12462 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
12463 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
12464 eat all memory.
12465
12466mode <mode>
12467 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
12468 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
12469 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
12470 UNIX sockets.
12471
12472mss <maxseg>
12473 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
12474 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
12475 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
12476 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
12477 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
12478 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
12479 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
12480 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
12481 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
12482 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
12483 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
12484
12485name <name>
12486 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
12487 page.
12488
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020012489namespace <name>
12490 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
12491 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
12492 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
12493 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
12494
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012495nice <nice>
12496 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
12497 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
12498 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
12499 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
12500 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
12501 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
12502 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
12503 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
12504 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
12505 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
12506 one for an RDP socket.
12507
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020012508no-ca-names
12509 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12510 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010012511 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020012512
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012513no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012514 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012515 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012516 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012517 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012518 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
12519 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012520
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020012521no-tls-tickets
12522 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12523 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
12524 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012525 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
12526 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010012527 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
12528 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
12529 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020012530
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012531no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012532 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012533 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012534 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012535 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012536 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
12537 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012538
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012539no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012540 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012541 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012542 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012543 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012544 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
12545 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012546
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020012547no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012548 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012549 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020012550 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010012551 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012552 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
12553 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020012554
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012555no-tlsv13
12556 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12557 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
12558 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
12559 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012560 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
12561 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020012562
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020012563npn <protocols>
12564 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
12565 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
12566 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012567 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020012568 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012569 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
12570 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
12571 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
12572 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
12573 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020012574
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000012575prefer-client-ciphers
12576 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
12577 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
12578 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020012579 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
12580 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
12581 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000012582
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010012583process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010012584 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010012585 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012586 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010012587 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
12588 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
12589 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
12590 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012591 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010012592 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
12593 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
12594 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
12595 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
12596 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010012597
12598 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
12599
12600 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
12601 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
12602 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
12603 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
12604 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
12605 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
12606 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
12607 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020012608
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020012609proto <name>
12610 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
12611 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
12612 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
12613 in haproxy -vv.
12614 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
12615 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080012616 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020012617 h2" on the bind line.
12618
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012619ssl
12620 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012621 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012622 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
12623 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020012624 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
12625 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012626
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012627ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
12628 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020012629 from this listener. Using this setting without "ssl-min-ver" can be
12630 ambiguous because the default ssl-min-ver value could change in future HAProxy
12631 versions. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012632 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
12633
12634ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020012635 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections
12636 instantiated from this listener. The default value is "TLSv1.2". This option
12637 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
12638 See also "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020012639
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010012640strict-sni
12641 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
12642 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
12643 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
12644 See the "crt" option for more information.
12645
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010012646tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012647 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010012648 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
12649 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012650 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010012651 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
12652 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
12653 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
12654 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
12655 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
12656 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
12657 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
12658
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020012659tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010012660 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020012661 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
12662 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
12663 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
12664 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
12665 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
12666 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
12667 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020012668 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
12669 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
12670 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020012671
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010012672tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
12673 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010012674 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
12675 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
12676 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
12677 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
12678 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
12679 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
12680 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
12681 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
12682 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
12683 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010012684 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
12685 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
12686
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012687transparent
12688 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
12689 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
12690 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
12691 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
12692 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
12693 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
12694 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
12695 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
12696 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
12697 so check for support with your vendor.
12698
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010012699v4v6
12700 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
12701 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
12702 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
12703 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012704 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010012705
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010012706v6only
12707 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
12708 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
12709 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010012710 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
12711 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010012712
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012713uid <uid>
12714 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
12715 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
12716 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
12717 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
12718 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12719
12720user <user>
12721 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
12722 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
12723 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
12724 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
12725 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
12726
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020012727verify [none|optional|required]
12728 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
12729 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
12730 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
12731 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
12732 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020012733 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
12734 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
12735 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
12736 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012737
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200127385.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010012739------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012740
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010012741The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
12742which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
12743arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
12744settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
12745after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
12746Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
12747address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012748
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012749 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010012750 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012751
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012752Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
12753keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
12754
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012755The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012756
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020012757addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012758 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010012759 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
12760 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
12761 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
12762 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
12763 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012764
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012765agent-check
12766 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012767 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010012768 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
12769 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
12770 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012771
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012772 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012773 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020012774 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
12775 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
12776 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012777
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012778 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
12779 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
12780 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
12781 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
12782 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020012783
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012784 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012785 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012786
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012787 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
12788 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
12789 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012790
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012791 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
12792 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
12793 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012794
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012795 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
12796 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
12797 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
12798 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
12799 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012800 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012801 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012802
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012803 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
12804 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012805
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012806 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
12807 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
12808 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
12809 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
12810 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
12811 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
12812 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
12813 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
12814 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012815
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090012816 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
12817 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012818 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
12819 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
12820 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010012821 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090012822
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010012823 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012824 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012825
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070012826agent-send <string>
12827 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
12828 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
12829 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
12830 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
12831 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
12832
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012833agent-inter <delay>
12834 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
12835 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
12836
12837 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
12838 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
12839 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
12840 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
12841 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
12842 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
12843 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
12844 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
12845 of backends use the same servers.
12846
12847 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
12848
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010012849agent-addr <addr>
12850 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
12851
12852 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
12853 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
12854 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
12855 hostname, it will be resolved.
12856
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090012857agent-port <port>
12858 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
12859
12860 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
12861
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020012862allow-0rtt
12863 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020012864 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
12865 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020012866
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012867alpn <protocols>
12868 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
12869 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
12870 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012871 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010012872 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
12873 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
12874 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
12875 now obsolete NPN extension.
12876 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
12877 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
12878
12879 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
12880
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012881backup
12882 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
12883 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
12884 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
12885 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012886 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
12887 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012888
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020012889ca-file <cafile>
12890 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
12891 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
12892 server's certificate.
12893
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012894check
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020012895 This option enables health checks on a server:
12896 - when not set, no health checking is performed, and the server is always
12897 considered available.
12898 - when set and no other check method is configured, the server is considered
12899 available when a connection can be established at the highest configured
12900 transport layer. This means TCP by default, or SSL/TLS when "ssl" or
12901 "check-ssl" are set, both possibly combined with connection prefixes such
12902 as a PROXY protocol header when "send-proxy" or "check-send-proxy" are
12903 set.
12904 - when set and an application-level health check is defined, the
12905 application-level exchanges are performed on top of the configured
12906 transport layer and the server is considered available if all of the
12907 exchanges succeed.
12908
12909 By default, health checks are performed on the same address and port as
12910 configured on the server, using the same encapsulation parameters (SSL/TLS,
12911 proxy-protocol header, etc... ). It is possible to change the destination
12912 address using "addr" and the port using "port". When done, it is assumed the
12913 server isn't checked on the service port, and configured encapsulation
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050012914 parameters are not reused. One must explicitly set "check-send-proxy" to send
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020012915 connection headers, "check-ssl" to use SSL/TLS.
12916
12917 When "sni" or "alpn" are set on the server line, their value is not used for
12918 health checks and one must use "check-sni" or "check-alpn".
12919
12920 The default source address for health check traffic is the same as the one
12921 defined in the backend. It can be changed with the "source" keyword.
12922
12923 The interval between checks can be set using the "inter" keyword, and the
12924 "rise" and "fall" keywords can be used to define how many successful or
12925 failed health checks are required to flag a server available or not
12926 available.
12927
12928 Optional application-level health checks can be configured with "option
12929 httpchk", "option mysql-check" "option smtpchk", "option pgsql-check",
12930 "option ldap-check", or "option redis-check".
12931
12932 Example:
12933 # simple tcp check
12934 backend foo
12935 server s1 192.168.0.1:80 check
12936 # this does a tcp connect + tls handshake
12937 backend foo
12938 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
12939 # simple tcp check is enough for check success
12940 backend foo
12941 option tcp-check
12942 tcp-check connect
12943 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010012944
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020012945check-send-proxy
12946 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
12947 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
12948 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
12949 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
12950 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
12951 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
12952 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
12953
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010012954check-alpn <protocols>
12955 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
12956 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
12957 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
12958
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020012959check-proto <name>
12960 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the server's health-check
12961 connections. It must be compatible with the health-check type (TCP or
12962 HTTP). It must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available
12963 protocols is reported in haproxy -vv.
12964 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
12965 protocol for health-check connections established to this server.
12966 If not defined, the server one will be used, if set.
12967
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010012968check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020012969 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010012970 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
12971 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020012972
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012973check-ssl
12974 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
12975 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
12976 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
12977 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012978 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012979 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
12980 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012981 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010012982 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
12983 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020012984
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012985check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012986 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080012987 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
12988 for normal traffic.
12989
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012990ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020012991 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
12992 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
12993 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000012994 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
12995 information and recommendations see e.g.
12996 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
12997 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
12998 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020012999
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013000ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
13001 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
13002 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
13003 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
13004 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013005 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
13006 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
13007 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013008
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013009cookie <value>
13010 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
13011 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
13012 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
13013 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
13014 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
13015 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
13016 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
13017
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013018crl-file <crlfile>
13019 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13020 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
13021 to verify server's certificate.
13022
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020013023crt <cert>
13024 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
13025 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
13026 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
13027 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
13028 certificate request.
13029
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020013030disabled
13031 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
13032 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
13033 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
13034 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
13035 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013036 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020013037
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013038enabled
13039 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
13040 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
13041 default value.
13042 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
13043 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020013044
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013045error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010013046 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
13047 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
13048 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013049
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013050 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013051
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013052fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013053 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
13054 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
13055 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
13056
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013057force-sslv3
13058 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
13059 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013060 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013061 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013062
13063force-tlsv10
13064 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013065 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013066 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013067
13068force-tlsv11
13069 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013070 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013071 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013072
13073force-tlsv12
13074 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013075 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013076 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013077
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013078force-tlsv13
13079 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
13080 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013081 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013082
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013083id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020013084 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
13085 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
13086 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013087
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013088init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
13089 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
13090 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013091 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013092 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
13093 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
13094 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
13095 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
13096 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
13097 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
13098 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
13099 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
13100 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013101 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013102 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
13103 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
13104 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
13105 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
13106 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
13107 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013108 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010013109
13110 Example:
13111 defaults
13112 # never fail on address resolution
13113 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
13114
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013115inter <delay>
13116fastinter <delay>
13117downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013118 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
13119 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
13120 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
13121 between checks depending on the server state :
13122
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020013123 Server state | Interval used
13124 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
13125 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
13126 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
13127 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
13128 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
13129 or yet unchecked. |
13130 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
13131 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
13132 | "inter" otherwise.
13133 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013134
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013135 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
13136 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
13137 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
13138 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013139 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
13140 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
13141 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
13142 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
13143 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013144
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +020013145log-proto <logproto>
13146 The "log-proto" specifies the protocol used to forward event messages to
13147 a server configured in a ring section. Possible values are "legacy"
13148 and "octet-count" corresponding respectively to "Non-transparent-framing"
13149 and "Octet counting" in rfc6587. "legacy" is the default.
13150
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013151maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013152 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
13153 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010013154 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
13155 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013156 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
13157 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
13158 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
13159 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
13160
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010013161 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
13162 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
13163 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
13164 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
13165 than 50 concurrent requests.
13166
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013167maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013168 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
13169 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
13170 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
13171 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
13172 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
13173 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
13174 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
13175
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010013176max-reuse <count>
13177 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
13178 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
13179 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
13180 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
13181 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
13182 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
13183 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
13184 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
13185
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013186minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013187 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
13188 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
13189 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
13190 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
13191 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
13192 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013193 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013194 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013195
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020013196namespace <name>
13197 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
13198 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
13199 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
13200 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
13201
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013202no-agent-check
13203 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
13204 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13205 default value.
13206 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13207 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
13208
13209no-backup
13210 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
13211 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13212 default value.
13213 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13214 "default-server" "backup" setting.
13215
13216no-check
13217 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
13218 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13219 default value.
13220 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13221 "default-server" "check" setting.
13222
13223no-check-ssl
13224 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
13225 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13226 default value.
13227 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13228 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
13229
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013230no-send-proxy
13231 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
13232 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13233 default value.
13234 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13235 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
13236
13237no-send-proxy-v2
13238 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
13239 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13240 default value.
13241 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13242 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
13243
13244no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
13245 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
13246 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13247 default value.
13248 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13249 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
13250
13251no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
13252 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
13253 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13254 default value.
13255 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13256 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
13257
13258no-ssl
13259 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
13260 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13261 default value.
13262 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13263 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
13264
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010013265no-ssl-reuse
13266 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
13267 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
13268 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
13269 and for paranoid users.
13270
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013271no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013272 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
13273 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013274 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013275
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013276 Supported in default-server: No
13277
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020013278no-tls-tickets
13279 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13280 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
13281 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013282 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
13283 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013284 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13285 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13286 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013287 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020013288
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013289no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013290 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013291 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13292 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013293 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13294 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013295 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013296
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013297 Supported in default-server: No
13298
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013299no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013300 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013301 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13302 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013303 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13304 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013305 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013306
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013307 Supported in default-server: No
13308
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013309no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013310 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013311 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13312 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013313 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13314 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013315 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013316
13317 Supported in default-server: No
13318
13319no-tlsv13
13320 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
13321 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
13322 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
13323 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
13324 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013325 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013326
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020013327 Supported in default-server: No
13328
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013329no-verifyhost
13330 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
13331 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13332 default value.
13333 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13334 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013335
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020013336no-tfo
13337 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
13338 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13339 default value.
13340 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13341 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
13342
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090013343non-stick
13344 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
13345 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
13346 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
13347
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013348npn <protocols>
13349 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
13350 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
13351 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013352 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013353 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
13354 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
13355 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
13356
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013357observe <mode>
13358 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
13359 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
13360 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
13361 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
13362 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
13363 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010013364 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013365
13366 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
13367
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013368on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013369 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
13370 Currently, four modes are available:
13371 - fastinter: force fastinter
13372 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
13373 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
13374 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
13375 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
13376
13377 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
13378
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090013379on-marked-down <action>
13380 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
13381 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013382 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
13383 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
13384 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
13385 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
13386 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
13387 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
13388 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
13389 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090013390
13391 Actions are disabled by default
13392
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013393on-marked-up <action>
13394 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
13395 Currently one action is available:
13396 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
13397 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
13398 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
13399 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013400 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
13401 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070013402 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
13403 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
13404
13405 Actions are disabled by default
13406
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020013407pool-low-conn <max>
13408 Set a low threshold on the number of idling connections for a server, below
13409 which a thread will not try to steal a connection from another thread. This
13410 can be useful to improve CPU usage patterns in scenarios involving many very
13411 fast servers, in order to ensure all threads will keep a few idle connections
13412 all the time instead of letting them accumulate over one thread and migrating
13413 them from thread to thread. Typical values of twice the number of threads
13414 seem to show very good performance already with sub-millisecond response
13415 times. The default is zero, indicating that any idle connection can be used
13416 at any time. It is the recommended setting for normal use. This only applies
13417 to connections that can be shared according to the same principles as those
13418 applying to "http-reuse".
13419
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010013420pool-max-conn <max>
13421 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
13422 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
13423 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
13424 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
13425 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
13426 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
13427
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010013428pool-purge-delay <delay>
13429 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010013430 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020013431 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010013432
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013433port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013434 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
13435 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
13436 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
13437 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
13438 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
13439 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
13440
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020013441proto <name>
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020013442 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
13443 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
13444 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
13445 reported in haproxy -vv.
13446 Idea behind this optipon is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
13447 protocol for all connections established to this server.
13448
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013449redir <prefix>
13450 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
13451 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
13452 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
13453 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
13454 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
13455 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
13456 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
13457 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013458 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013459 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013460 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
13461 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
13462 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
13463 loop between the client and HAProxy!
13464
13465 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
13466
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013467rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013468 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
13469 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
13470 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
13471
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020013472resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
13473 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
13474 server.
13475
13476 Available options:
13477
13478 * allow-dup-ip
13479 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
13480 resolution at runtime is in operation.
13481 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
13482 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
13483 For such case, simply enable this option.
13484 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
13485
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050013486 * ignore-weight
13487 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
13488 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
13489 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
13490
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020013491 * prevent-dup-ip
13492 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
13493 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
13494 same fqdn.
13495 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
13496
13497 Example:
13498 backend b_myapp
13499 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
13500 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
13501 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
13502
13503 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
13504 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
13505 it
13506 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
13507 different address
13508
13509 Default value: not set
13510
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013511resolve-prefer <family>
13512 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
13513 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
13514 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
13515 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
13516
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020013517 Default value: ipv6
13518
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013519 Example:
13520
13521 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013522
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010013523resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013524 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010013525 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013526 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013527 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
13528 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010013529 configured network, another address is selected.
13530
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013531 Example:
13532
13533 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010013534
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013535resolvers <id>
13536 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
13537 hostname.
13538
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013539 Example:
13540
13541 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013542
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013543 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013544
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010013545send-proxy
13546 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
13547 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
13548 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
13549 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013550 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
13551 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
13552 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
13553 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
13554 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
13555 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
13556 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
13557 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
13558 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
13559 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013560 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
13561 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010013562
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013563send-proxy-v2
13564 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
13565 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
13566 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
13567 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020013568 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
13569 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
13570 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
13571 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013572
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010013573proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010013574 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
13575 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
13576
13577 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
13578 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
13579 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
13580 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
13581 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
13582 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
13583 connection is supported).
13584 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
13585 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
13586 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
13587 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
13588 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
13589 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
13590 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010013591
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013592send-proxy-v2-ssl
13593 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
13594 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
13595 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
13596 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
13597 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
13598 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
13599 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013600 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
13601 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013602
13603send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
13604 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
13605 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
13606 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
13607 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
13608 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
13609 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
13610 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
13611 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013612 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
13613 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040013614
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013615slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013616 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
13617 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
13618 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
13619 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
13620 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
13621 parameters :
13622
13623 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
13624 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
13625
13626 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
13627 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
13628 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
13629 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
13630
13631 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
13632 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
13633 seen as failed.
13634
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020013635sni <expression>
13636 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
13637 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
13638 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
13639 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020013640 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
13641 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020013642 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010013643 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
13644 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020013645
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020013646source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020013647source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020013648source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013649 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
13650 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
13651 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
13652 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
13653
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020013654 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
13655 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
13656 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
13657 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
13658 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
13659 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
13660 server.
13661
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000013662 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
13663 specifying the source address without port(s).
13664
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013665ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020013666 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
13667 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
13668 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
13669 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
13670 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
13671 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013672 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
13673 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013674
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013675ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
13676 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
13677 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
13678 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
13679
13680ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
13681 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
13682 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
13683 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
13684
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013685ssl-reuse
13686 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
13687 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13688 default value.
13689 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13690 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
13691
13692stick
13693 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
13694 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13695 default value.
13696 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
13697 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013698
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013699socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013700 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013701 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
13702 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
13703
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020013704tcp-ut <delay>
13705 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
13706 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
13707 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013708 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020013709 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
13710 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
13711 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
13712 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
13713 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
13714 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
13715 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
13716 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
13717 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
13718
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010013719tfo
13720 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
13721 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
13722 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
13723 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
13724 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or haproxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020013725 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010013726
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013727track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020013728 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
13729 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
13730 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
13731 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013732 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
13733
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013734tls-tickets
13735 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
13736 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
13737 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013738 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13739 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13740 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013741 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010013742 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013743
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013744verify [none|required]
13745 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010013746 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020013747 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
13748 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013749 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020013750 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
13751 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
13752 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
13753 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
13754 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
13755 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
13756 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
13757 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013758
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070013759verifyhost <hostname>
13760 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020013761 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
13762 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
13763 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
13764 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
13765 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
13766 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
13767 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
13768 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070013769
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013770weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013771 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
13772 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
13773 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020013774 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
13775 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
13776 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
13777 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
13778 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
13779 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013780
13781
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200137825.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
13783-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013784
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013785HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
13786using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
13787configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013788This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
13789can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
13790workload.
13791This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
13792resolution at run time.
13793Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
13794carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
13795
13796
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200137975.3.1. Global overview
13798----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013799
13800As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
13801different steps of the process life:
13802
13803 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
13804 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
13805 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
13806
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013807 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
13808 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013809
13810A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
13811 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
13812 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
13813 resolution to know this new IP.
13814
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013815When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013816HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013817SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
13818from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
13819will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
13820will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020013821
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013822A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013823 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013824 first valid response.
13825
13826 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
13827 servers return an error.
13828
13829
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200138305.3.2. The resolvers section
13831----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013832
13833This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013834HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
13835contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013836
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013837When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
13838uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
13839is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
13840answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
13841
13842When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013843used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013844
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013845 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
13846 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
13847 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013848
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013849 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
13850 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013851
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013852 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
13853 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
13854 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013855
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013856For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
13857following scenarios are possible:
13858
13859 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
13860 ignored
13861
13862 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
13863 applied
13864
13865 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
13866 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
13867
13868 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
13869 retries the query with a new type
13870
13871 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
13872 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013873
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013874As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
13875a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013876<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013877
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013878
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013879resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013880 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013881
13882A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
13883
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020013884accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013885 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013886 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020013887 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
13888 by RFC 6891)
13889
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020013890 Note: the maximum allowed value is 8192.
13891
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013892nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
13893 DNS server description:
13894 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
13895 <ip> : IP address of the server
13896 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
13897
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060013898parse-resolv-conf
13899 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
13900 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
13901 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
13902
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013903hold <status> <period>
13904 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
13905 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010013906 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013907 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013908 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
13909 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
13910 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
13911
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020013912 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013913
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013914resolve_retries <nb>
13915 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
13916 giving up.
13917 Default value: 3
13918
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020013919 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
13920 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
13921 type.
13922
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013923timeout <event> <time>
13924 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
13925 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
13926 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013927 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
13928 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013929 Default value: 1s
13930 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010013931 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013932 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013933 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
13934 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
13935
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020013936 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013937
13938 resolvers mydns
13939 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
13940 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060013941 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013942 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020013943 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013944 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010013945 hold other 30s
13946 hold refused 30s
13947 hold nx 30s
13948 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013949 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020013950 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020013951
13952
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200139536. Cache
13954---------
13955
13956HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
13957(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
13958RAM.
13959
13960The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
13961this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
13962
13963If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
13964independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
13965when we try to allocate a new one.
13966
13967The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
13968
13969It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
13970"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
13971for more details.
13972
13973When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
13974replaced by "<CACHE>".
13975
13976
139776.1. Limitation
13978----------------
13979
13980The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
13981
13982- If the response is not a 200
13983- If the response contains a Vary header
13984- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
13985- If the response is not cacheable
13986
13987- If the request is not a GET
13988- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
13989- If the request contains an Authorization header
13990
13991
139926.2. Setup
13993-----------
13994
13995To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
13996the corresponding http-request and response actions.
13997
13998
139996.2.1. Cache section
14000---------------------
14001
14002cache <name>
14003 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
14004 size of cache is mandatory.
14005
14006total-max-size <megabytes>
14007 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
14008 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
14009
14010max-object-size <bytes>
14011 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
14012 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
14013 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
14014
14015max-age <seconds>
14016 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set has the lowest
14017 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
14018 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
14019 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
14020 default.
14021
14022
140236.2.2. Proxy section
14024---------------------
14025
14026http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14027 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
14028 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
14029 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
14030 after this one.
14031
14032http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14033 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
14034 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
14035 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
14036 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
14037
14038
14039Example:
14040
14041 backend bck1
14042 mode http
14043
14044 http-request cache-use foobar
14045 http-response cache-store foobar
14046 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
14047
14048 cache foobar
14049 total-max-size 4
14050 max-age 240
14051
14052
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200140537. Using ACLs and fetching samples
14054----------------------------------
14055
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014056HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014057client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
14058The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
14059these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
14060but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
14061data called patterns.
14062
14063
140647.1. ACL basics
14065---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014066
14067The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
14068content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
14069from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
14070simple :
14071
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014072 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014073 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014074 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
14075 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014076
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014077The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
14078adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014079
14080In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
14081
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014082 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014083
14084This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
14085Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
14086and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014087an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
14088conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
14089as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
14090are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014091
14092ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
14093'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
14094which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
14095
14096There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
14097performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
14098
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014099The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
14100specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
14101this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014102methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
14103ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014104
14105Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
14106 - boolean
14107 - integer (signed or unsigned)
14108 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
14109 - string
14110 - data block
14111
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014112Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
14113converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
14114would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
14115The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
14116which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
14117
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014118Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
14119keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
14120fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
14121which are summarized in the table below :
14122
14123 +---------------------+-----------------+
14124 | Sample or converter | Default |
14125 | output type | matching method |
14126 +---------------------+-----------------+
14127 | boolean | bool |
14128 +---------------------+-----------------+
14129 | integer | int |
14130 +---------------------+-----------------+
14131 | ip | ip |
14132 +---------------------+-----------------+
14133 | string | str |
14134 +---------------------+-----------------+
14135 | binary | none, use "-m" |
14136 +---------------------+-----------------+
14137
14138Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
14139matching method, see below.
14140
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014141The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
14142 - boolean
14143 - integer or integer range
14144 - IP address / network
14145 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
14146 - regular expression
14147 - hex block
14148
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014149The following ACL flags are currently supported :
14150
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014151 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
14152 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014153 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010014154 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010014155 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010014156 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014157 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
14158
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014159The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
14160read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
14161if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
14162lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
14163will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
14164beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
14165a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
14166lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
14167exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
14168
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010014169The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
14170parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
14171ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
14172a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
14173check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
14174
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010014175The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
14176socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
14177file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
14178
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014179Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
14180loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
14181
14182 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
14183
14184In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
14185the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
14186case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
14187as well.
14188
14189The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
14190sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
14191do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
14192methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
14193is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014194obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014195followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
14196default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
14197that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
14198string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
14199
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010014200The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
14201By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
14202string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
14203resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
14204server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014205waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010014206flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
14207function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
14208
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014209There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
14210sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
14211be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014212
14213 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
14214 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014215 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
14216 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
14217 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
14218 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014219
14220 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
14221 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014222 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014223
14224 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014225 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014226
14227 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014228 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014229
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014230 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014231 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
14232
14233 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
14234 binary or string samples.
14235
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014236 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
14237 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014238
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014239 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
14240 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
14241 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014242
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014243 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
14244 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014245
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014246 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
14247 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014248
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014249 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
14250 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014251
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014252 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
14253 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014254 This may be used with binary or string samples.
14255
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014256 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
14257 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
14258 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020014259
14260For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
14261request, it is possible to do :
14262
14263 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
14264
14265In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
14266buffer, one would use the following acl :
14267
14268 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
14269
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014270On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
14271possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
14272
14273 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
14274
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014275All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
14276criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
14277method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
14278to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
14279criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
14280the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014281
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014282If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014283the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
14284For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014285
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014286 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
14287 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
14288 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
14289 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014290
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020014291
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014292The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
14293types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
14294combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
14295brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
14296default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014297
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014298 +-------------------------------------------------+
14299 | Input sample type |
14300 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014301 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014302 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
14303 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
14304 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014305 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014306 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014307 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014308 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014309 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014310 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014311 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014312 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020014313 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014314 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014315 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014316 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014317 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014318 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014319 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014320 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014321 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014322 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014323 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014324 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010014325 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014326 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
14327 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
14328 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014329
14330
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200143317.1.1. Matching booleans
14332------------------------
14333
14334In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
14335Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
14336When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
14337that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
14338
14339Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
14340return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
14341"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
14342
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014343
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200143447.1.2. Matching integers
14345------------------------
14346
14347Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
14348enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
14349to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
14350
14351Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
14352matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
14353lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014354
14355For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
14356unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
14357representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
14358
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014359As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
14360two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
14361instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
14362ranges and operators.
14363
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014364For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014365operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
14366Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
14367of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014368
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014369Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014370
14371 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
14372 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
14373 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
14374 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
14375 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
14376
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014377For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014378
14379 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
14380
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014381This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
14382
14383 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
14384
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014385
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200143867.1.3. Matching strings
14387-----------------------
14388
14389String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
14390different forms :
14391
14392 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014393 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014394
14395 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014396 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014397
14398 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
14399 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
14400
14401 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
14402 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
14403
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010014404 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014405 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
14406 matches.
14407
14408 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
14409 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
14410 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014411
14412String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
14413exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
14414characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
14415string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
14416to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014417before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014418
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010014419Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
14420(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
14421Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
14422
14423Example:
14424 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
14425 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
14426
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014427
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200144287.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
14429---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014430
14431Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
14432they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
14433possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
14434passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
14435the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014436the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
14437match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014438
14439
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200144407.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
14441-------------------------------------
14442
14443It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
14444not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
14445a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
14446to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
14447digits may be used upper or lower case.
14448
14449Example :
14450 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
14451 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
14452
14453
144547.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
14455---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014456
14457IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
14458netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
14459within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010014460host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014461difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
14462at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
14463does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
14464parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014465
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020014466The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
14467abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
14468
14469 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
14470 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
14471 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
14472 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
14473 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
14474 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
14475 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
14476 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
14477
14478Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
14479192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
14480
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020014481IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
14482Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
14483trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
14484IPv6 patterns.
14485
14486HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
14487following situations :
14488 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
14489 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
14490 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
14491 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
14492 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
14493 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
14494 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
14495 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
14496 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
14497 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
14498
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014499
145007.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
14501----------------------------------
14502
14503Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
14504combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
14505
14506 - AND (implicit)
14507 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
14508 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014509
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014510A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014511
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014512 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020014513
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014514Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
14515indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020014516
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014517For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
14518"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
14519requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
14520is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
14521
14522 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030014523 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
14524 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
14525 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014526
14527To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
14528and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
14529
14530 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
14531 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
14532 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
14533 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
14534
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014535 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014536 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
14537 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
14538 use_backend www if host_www
14539
14540It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
14541expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
14542be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
14543the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
14544
14545 The following rule :
14546
14547 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030014548 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014549
14550 Can also be written that way :
14551
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030014552 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014553
14554It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
14555to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
14556simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
14557sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
14558good use is the following :
14559
14560 With named ACLs :
14561
14562 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
14563 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
14564 monitor fail if site_dead
14565
14566 With anonymous ACLs :
14567
14568 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
14569
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030014570See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
14571keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014572
14573
145747.3. Fetching samples
14575---------------------
14576
14577Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
14578against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
14579sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
14580ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
14581of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
14582available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
14583
14584This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
14585Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
14586compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
14587deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
14588
14589The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
14590matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
14591method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
14592indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
14593
14594As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
14595when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
14596mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
14597the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
14598ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
14599
14600Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
14601multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
14602when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014603incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
14604are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014605is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
14606all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
14607
14608Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
14609 - name
14610 - name(arg1)
14611 - name(arg1,arg2)
14612
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014613
146147.3.1. Converters
14615-----------------
14616
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014617Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
14618of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
14619is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
14620was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014621has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010014622unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
14623
14624These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
14625sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
14626the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014627support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014628
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014629A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
14630support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
14631supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
14632(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
14633bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
14634
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014635The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014636
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001463751d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
14638 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
14639 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
14640 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
14641 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
14642 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
14643
14644 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014645 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
14646 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000014647 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
14648 frontend http-in
14649 bind *:8081
14650 default_backend servers
14651 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
14652 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
14653
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014654add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014655 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014656 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014657 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
14658 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014659 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014660 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14661 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14662 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14663 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014664 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014665 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014666
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010014667aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
14668 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
14669 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
14670 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
14671 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
14672 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
14673 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
14674
14675 Example:
14676 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
14677 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
14678
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014679and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014680 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014681 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014682 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
14683 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014684 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014685 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14686 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14687 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14688 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014689 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014690 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014691
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020014692b64dec
14693 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
14694 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
14695
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020014696base64
14697 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014698 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020014699 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
14700
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014701bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014702 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014703 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014704 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014705 presence of a flag).
14706
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010014707bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
14708 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
14709 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014710 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010014711
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010014712concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
14713 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
14714 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
14715 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
14716 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
14717 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
14718 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
14719 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
14720 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
14721 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
14722 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010014723 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
14724 parethesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
14725 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
14726 level parser. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010014727
14728 Example:
14729 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
14730 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
14731 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010014732 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010014733 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
14734
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014735cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014736 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
14737 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014738
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010014739crc32([<avalanche>])
14740 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
14741 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14742 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14743 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14744 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14745 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
14746 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
14747 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
14748 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
14749 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014750 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
14751
14752crc32c([<avalanche>])
14753 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
14754 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14755 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14756 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
14757 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
14758 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
14759 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
14760 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010014761
Christopher Fauletea159d62020-04-01 16:21:44 +020014762cut_crlf
14763 Cuts the string representation of the input sample on the first carriage
14764 return ('\r') or newline ('\n') character found. Only the string length is
14765 updated.
14766
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010014767da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020014768 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
14769 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
14770 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
14771 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000014772 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020014773 configuration language.
14774
14775 Example:
14776 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020014777 bind *:8881
14778 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000014779 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020014780
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010014781debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
14782 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
14783 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
14784 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
14785 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
14786 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
14787 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
14788 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
14789 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
14790 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
14791 printable sample types.
14792
14793 Example:
14794 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020014795
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020014796digest(<algorithm>)
14797 Converts a binary input sample to a message digest. The result is a binary
14798 sample. The <algorithm> must be an OpenSSL message digest name (e.g. sha256).
14799
14800 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
14801 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
14802
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014803div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014804 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
14805 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020014806 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014807 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
14808 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010014809 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010014810 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
14811 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
14812 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
14813 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014814 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010014815 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014816
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014817djb2([<avalanche>])
14818 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
14819 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
14820 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
14821 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
14822 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
14823 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
14824 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010014825 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
14826 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014827
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014828even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020014829 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010014830 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
14831
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020014832field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
14833 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
14834 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
14835 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
14836 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
14837 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
14838 fields.
14839
14840 Example :
14841 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
14842 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
14843 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
14844 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
14845 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010014846
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014847hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014848 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014849 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014850 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014851 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010014852
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020014853hex2i
14854 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014855 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020014856
Christopher Faulet4ccc12f2020-04-01 09:08:32 +020014857htonl
14858 Converts the input integer value to its 32-bit binary representation in the
14859 network byte order. Because sample fetches own signed 64-bit integer, when
14860 this converter is used, the input integer value is first casted to an
14861 unsigned 32-bit integer.
14862
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020014863hmac(<algorithm>, <key>)
14864 Converts a binary input sample to a message authentication code with the given
14865 key. The result is a binary sample. The <algorithm> must be one of the
14866 registered OpenSSL message digest names (e.g. sha256). The <key> parameter must
14867 be base64 encoded and can either be a string or a variable.
14868
14869 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
14870 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
14871
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010014872http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014873 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
14874 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000014875 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
14876 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
14877 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
14878 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
14879 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
14880 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
14881 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
14882 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014883
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014884in_table(<table>)
14885 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
14886 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
14887 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014888 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020014889 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
14890
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010014891ipmask(<mask4>, [<mask6>])
14892 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014893 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010014894 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
14895 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
14896 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
14897 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
14898 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014899
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014900json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014901 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014902 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020014903 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014904 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
14905 of errors:
14906 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
14907 bytes, ...)
14908 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
14909 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
14910
14911 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
14912 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
14913 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
14914 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
14915 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
14916 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014917 - "ascii" : never fails;
14918 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
14919 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014920 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014921 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014922 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
14923 characters corresponding to the other errors.
14924
14925 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014926 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014927
14928 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014929 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020014930 capture request header user-agent len 150
14931 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020014932
14933 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
14934 GET / HTTP/1.0
14935 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
14936
14937 Output log:
14938 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
14939
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014940language(<value>[,<default>])
14941 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
14942 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
14943 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
14944 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
14945 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
14946 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
14947 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
14948 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
14949 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014950 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014951 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
14952 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014953
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014954 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014955
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014956 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
14957 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014958
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014959 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
14960 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
14961 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
14962 use_backend spanish if es
14963 use_backend french if fr
14964 use_backend english if en
14965 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020014966
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010014967length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010014968 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
14969 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14970 type. The result is of type integer.
14971
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020014972lower
14973 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
14974 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
14975 type. The result is of type string.
14976
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014977ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
14978 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
14979 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
14980 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
14981 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
14982 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
14983 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
14984
14985 Example :
14986
14987 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014988 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020014989 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
14990
Christopher Faulet51fc9d12020-04-01 17:24:41 +020014991ltrim(<chars>)
14992 Skips any characters from <chars> from the beginning of the string
14993 representation of the input sample.
14994
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020014995map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
14996map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
14997map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
14998 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
14999 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
15000 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
15001 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
15002 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
15003 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
15004 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
15005 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015006
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015007 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
15008 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
15009 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015010
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010015011 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015012 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015013
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015014 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
15015 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15016 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
15017 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020015018 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
15019 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015020 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
15021 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15022 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
15023 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15024 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
15025 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15026 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
15027 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080015028 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
15029 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15030 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015031 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15032 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
15033 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
15034 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
15035 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015036
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010015037 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
15038 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
15039 the corresponding match text.
15040
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015041 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
15042 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
15043 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
15044 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
15045 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015046
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015047 Example :
15048
15049 # this is a comment and is ignored
15050 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
15051 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
15052 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
15053 | | | `---------- value
15054 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
15055 | `---------------------------- key
15056 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
15057
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015058mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015059 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
15060 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015061 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015062 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015063 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015064 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15065 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15066 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15067 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015068 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015069 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015070
15071mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015072 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020015073 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
15074 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015075 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015076 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015077 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015078 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15079 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15080 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15081 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015082 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015083 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015084
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010015085nbsrv
15086 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
15087 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
15088 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
15089 map lookup.
15090
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015091neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015092 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
15093 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
15094 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
15095 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015096
15097not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015098 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015099 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015100 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015101 absence of a flag).
15102
15103odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015104 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015105 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
15106
15107or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015108 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015109 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015110 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
15111 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015112 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015113 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15114 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15115 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15116 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015117 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015118 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015119
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010015120protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
15121 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
15122 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
15123 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
15124 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
15125 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
15126 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
15127 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
15128 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
15129 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
15130 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
15131 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
15132
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010015133regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015134 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
15135 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
15136 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
15137 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
15138 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
15139 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
15140 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
15141 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
15142 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015143 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
15144 of characters with other ones.
15145
15146 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
15147 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
15148 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
15149 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
15150 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
15151 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015152
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010015153 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015154
15155 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
15156 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
15157 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015158 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010015159
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010015160 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
15161 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
15162
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010015163 # capture groups and backreferences
15164 # both lines do the same.
15165 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)]'
15166 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
15167
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020015168capture-req(<id>)
15169 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
15170 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
15171
15172 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020015173 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
15174 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020015175
15176capture-res(<id>)
15177 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
15178 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
15179
15180 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020015181 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
15182 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020015183
Christopher Faulet568415a2020-04-01 17:24:47 +020015184rtrim(<chars>)
15185 Skips any characters from <chars> from the end of the string representation
15186 of the input sample.
15187
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015188sdbm([<avalanche>])
15189 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
15190 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15191 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15192 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15193 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15194 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
15195 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015196 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
15197 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015198
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020015199secure_memcmp(<var>)
15200 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value. Both values are treated
15201 as a binary string. Returns a boolean indicating whether both binary strings
15202 match.
15203
15204 If both binary strings have the same length then the comparison will be
15205 performed in constant time.
15206
15207 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15208 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15209
15210 Example :
15211
15212 http-request set-var(txn.token) hdr(token)
15213 # Check whether the token sent by the client matches the secret token
15214 # value, without leaking the contents using a timing attack.
15215 acl token_given str(my_secret_token),secure_memcmp(txn.token)
15216
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015217set-var(<var name>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015218 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
15219 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
15220 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015221 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015222 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15223 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015224 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015225 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15226 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015227 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015228 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020015229
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020015230sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020015231 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020015232 sample with length of 20 bytes.
15233
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020015234sha2([<bits>])
15235 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
15236 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
15237
15238 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
15239 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
15240
15241 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15242 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15243
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020015244srv_queue
15245 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
15246 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
15247 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
15248 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
15249 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
15250
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020015251strcmp(<var>)
15252 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
15253 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
15254 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
15255 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
15256 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
15257 shorter).
15258
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020015259 See also the secure_memcmp converter if you need to compare two binary
15260 strings in constant time.
15261
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020015262 Example :
15263
15264 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
15265 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
15266 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
15267
15268
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015269sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015270 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
15271 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015272 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015273 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
15274 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015275 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015276 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15277 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015278 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015279 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15280 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015281 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015282 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015283
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015284table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
15285 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15286 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15287 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
15288 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
15289 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
15290 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
15291
15292
15293table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
15294 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15295 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15296 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
15297 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
15298 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
15299 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
15300
15301table_conn_cnt(<table>)
15302 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15303 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015304 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015305 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
15306 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
15307
15308table_conn_cur(<table>)
15309 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15310 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15311 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
15312 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
15313 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
15314
15315table_conn_rate(<table>)
15316 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15317 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15318 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
15319 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
15320 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
15321
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020015322table_gpt0(<table>)
15323 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15324 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
15325 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
15326 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
15327 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
15328
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015329table_gpc0(<table>)
15330 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15331 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15332 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
15333 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
15334 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
15335
15336table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
15337 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15338 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15339 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
15340 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
15341 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
15342 sample fetch keyword.
15343
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010015344table_gpc1(<table>)
15345 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15346 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15347 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
15348 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
15349 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
15350
15351table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
15352 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15353 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15354 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
15355 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
15356 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
15357 sample fetch keyword.
15358
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015359table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
15360 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15361 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015362 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015363 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
15364 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
15365
15366table_http_err_rate(<table>)
15367 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15368 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15369 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
15370 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
15371 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
15372 keyword.
15373
15374table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
15375 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15376 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015377 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015378 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
15379 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
15380
15381table_http_req_rate(<table>)
15382 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15383 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15384 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
15385 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
15386 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
15387 keyword.
15388
15389table_kbytes_in(<table>)
15390 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15391 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015392 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015393 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
15394 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
15395 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
15396 keyword.
15397
15398table_kbytes_out(<table>)
15399 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15400 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015401 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015402 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
15403 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
15404 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
15405 keyword.
15406
15407table_server_id(<table>)
15408 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15409 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15410 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
15411 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
15412 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
15413 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
15414
15415table_sess_cnt(<table>)
15416 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15417 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015418 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015419 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
15420 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
15421 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
15422 keyword.
15423
15424table_sess_rate(<table>)
15425 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15426 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15427 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
15428 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
15429 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
15430 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
15431 keyword.
15432
15433table_trackers(<table>)
15434 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15435 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
15436 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
15437 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
15438 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
15439 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
15440 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
15441 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
15442 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
15443 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
15444
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015445upper
15446 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
15447 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
15448 type. The result is of type string.
15449
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020015450url_dec([<in_form>])
15451 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
15452 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
15453 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
15454 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
15455 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
15456 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020015457
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015458ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010015459 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010015460 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
15461 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
15462 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015463 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
15464 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
15465 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
15466 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015467 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015468 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
15469 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010015470
15471 Example:
15472 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
15473 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
15474
15475 message Point {
15476 int32 latitude = 1;
15477 int32 longitude = 2;
15478 }
15479
15480 message PPoint {
15481 Point point = 59;
15482 }
15483
15484 message Rectangle {
15485 // One corner of the rectangle.
15486 PPoint lo = 48;
15487 // The other corner of the rectangle.
15488 PPoint hi = 49;
15489 }
15490
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020015491 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
15492 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
15493 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010015494
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015495 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
15496 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015497 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015498 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
15499
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020015500 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015501
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015502 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010015503
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020015504 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
15505 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
15506 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010015507
15508 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
15509 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
15510 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
15511
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020015512 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
15513 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
15514 interpret the previous binary sample.
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010015515
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010015516
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010015517unset-var(<var name>)
15518 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
15519 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
15520 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
15521 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15522 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
15523 response),
15524 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15525 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
15526 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
15527 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
15528
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015529utime(<format>[,<offset>])
15530 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
15531 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
15532 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
15533 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
15534 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
15535 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
15536
15537 Example :
15538
15539 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015540 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020015541 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
15542
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020015543word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
15544 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
15545 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
15546 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010015547 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020015548 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
15549 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
15550
15551 Example :
15552 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
15553 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
15554 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
15555 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
15556 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010015557 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010015558
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015559wt6([<avalanche>])
15560 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
15561 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15562 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15563 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15564 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15565 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
15566 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015567 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
15568 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015569
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015570xor(<value>)
15571 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015572 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015573 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015574 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015575 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015576 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15577 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015578 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015579 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
15580 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015581 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015582 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015583
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010015584xxh32([<seed>])
15585 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
15586 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
15587 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
15588 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
15589 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
15590 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
15591 as cryptographically secure.
15592
15593xxh64([<seed>])
15594 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
15595 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
15596 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
15597 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
15598 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
15599 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
15600 as cryptographically secure.
15601
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010015602
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200156037.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015604--------------------------------------------
15605
15606A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
15607not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
15608"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
15609The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
15610
15611always_false : boolean
15612 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
15613 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
15614
15615always_true : boolean
15616 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
15617 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
15618
15619avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015620 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015621 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
15622 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
15623 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
15624 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
15625 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
15626 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
15627 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
15628 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
15629 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
15630 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
15631 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
15632 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
15633 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010015634
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015635be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020015636 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
15637 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
15638 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
15639 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040015640 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
15641
15642be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
15643 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
15644 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
15645 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
15646 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
15647 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040015648 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
15649 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040015650
15651 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
15652 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
15653 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015654
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015655be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
15656 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
15657 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
15658 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015659 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015660 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
15661 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015662
15663 Example :
15664 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
15665 backend dynamic
15666 mode http
15667 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
15668 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015669
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015670bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020015671 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
15672 of the string.
15673
15674bool(<bool>) : bool
15675 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
15676 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
15677
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015678connslots([<backend>]) : integer
15679 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015680 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015681 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
15682 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050015683
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015684 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015685 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015686 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
15687
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015688 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
15689 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015690
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020015691 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015692 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015693 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015694 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015695 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015696 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020015697 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015698
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015699 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
15700 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015701 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015702 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080015703
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010015704cpu_calls : integer
15705 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
15706 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
15707 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
15708 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
15709 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
15710 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
15711
15712cpu_ns_avg : integer
15713 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
15714 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
15715 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
15716 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
15717 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
15718 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
15719 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
15720 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
15721 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
15722 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
15723 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
15724
15725cpu_ns_tot : integer
15726 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
15727 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
15728 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
15729 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
15730 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
15731 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
15732 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
15733 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
15734 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
15735 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
15736 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
15737 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
15738 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
15739
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010015740date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020015741 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000015742
15743 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
15744 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
15745 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020015746 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
15747
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000015748 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
15749 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
15750 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
15751 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
15752 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
15753
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020015754 Example :
15755
15756 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
15757 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020015758
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000015759 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
15760 # millisecond granularity
15761 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
15762
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010015763date_us : integer
15764 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
15765 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
15766 from the same timeval structure.
15767
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020015768distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
15769 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
15770 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
15771 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
15772 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
15773 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
15774 list of supported tokens.
15775
15776distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
15777 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
15778 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
15779 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
15780 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
15781 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
15782 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
15783 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
15784 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
15785 supported tokens.
15786
15787 Example :
15788 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
15789 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
15790 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
15791 # send large files to the big farm
15792 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
15793
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020015794env(<name>) : string
15795 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
15796 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
15797 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
15798 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
15799 certain way.
15800
15801 Examples :
15802 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
15803 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
15804
15805 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
15806 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
15807
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015808fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
15809 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015810 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
15811 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015812 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
15813 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015814 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015815 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
15816 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020015817
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020015818fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
15819 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
15820 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
15821 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
15822
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015823fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
15824 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
15825 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
15826 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
15827 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
15828 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
15829 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
15830 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
15831 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010015832
15833 Example :
15834 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
15835 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
15836 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
15837 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
15838 frontend mail
15839 bind :25
15840 mode tcp
15841 maxconn 100
15842 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
15843 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
15844 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
15845 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015846
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010015847hostname : string
15848 Returns the system hostname.
15849
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015850int(<integer>) : signed integer
15851 Returns a signed integer.
15852
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020015853ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
15854 Returns an ipv4.
15855
15856ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
15857 Returns an ipv6.
15858
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010015859lat_ns_avg : integer
15860 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
15861 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
15862 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
15863 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
15864 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
15865 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
15866 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
15867 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
15868 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020015869 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
15870 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
15871 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
15872 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
15873 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: this value is
15874 exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010015875
15876lat_ns_tot : integer
15877 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
15878 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
15879 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
15880 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
15881 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
15882 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
15883 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
15884 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
15885 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020015886 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
15887 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
15888 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
15889 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
15890 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010015891 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
15892 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
15893 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
15894 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
15895 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
15896 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
15897
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020015898meth(<method>) : method
15899 Returns a method.
15900
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010015901nbproc : integer
15902 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
15903 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
15904 and debugging purposes.
15905
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015906nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
15907 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
15908 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
15909 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015910 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
15911 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
15912 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010015913
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040015914prio_class : integer
15915 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
15916 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
15917 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
15918
15919prio_offset : integer
15920 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
15921 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
15922 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
15923 set-priority-offset".
15924
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010015925proc : integer
15926 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
15927 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
15928 debugging purposes.
15929
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015930queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015931 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
15932 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
15933 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015934 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
15935 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
15936 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
15937 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
15938 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
15939
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010015940rand([<range>]) : integer
15941 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
15942 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
15943 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
15944 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
15945 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
15946
Luca Schimweg8a694b82019-09-10 15:42:52 +020015947uuid([<version>]) : string
15948 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
15949 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
15950 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
15951
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015952srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15953 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
15954 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
15955 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
15956 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
15957 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040015958 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
15959 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
15960
15961srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15962 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
15963 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
15964 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
15965 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
15966 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
15967 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
15968 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
15969
15970 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
15971 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015972
15973srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
15974 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
15975 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
15976 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015977 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015978 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
15979 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
15980 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
15981
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020015982srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15983 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
15984 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
15985 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
15986 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
15987 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
15988 fetch methods.
15989
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015990srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
15991 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
15992 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015993 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015994 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
15995 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015996 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015997 overloading servers).
15998
15999 Example :
16000 # Redirect to a separate back
16001 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
16002 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
16003 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
16004
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010016005stopping : boolean
16006 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
16007 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
16008 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
16009
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020016010str(<string>) : string
16011 Returns a string.
16012
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016013table_avl([<table>]) : integer
16014 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
16015 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
16016
16017table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16018 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
16019 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
16020 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
16021
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010016022thread : integer
16023 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
16024 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
16025 and debugging purposes.
16026
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016027var(<var-name>) : undefined
16028 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016029 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
16030 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016031 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016032 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16033 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016034 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016035 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16036 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016037 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016038 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016039
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200160407.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016041----------------------------------
16042
16043The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
16044closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
16045methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
16046sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
16047TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016048the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
16049counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020016050"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
16051used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
16052can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
16053Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
16054table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
16055tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
16056currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016057
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010016058bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010016059 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
16060 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
16061 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
16062
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016063be_id : integer
16064 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020016065 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
16066 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016067
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010016068be_name : string
16069 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020016070 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
16071 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010016072
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016073dst : ip
16074 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
16075 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
16076 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
16077 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010016078 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
16079 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
16080 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
16081 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
16082 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
16083 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016084
16085dst_conn : integer
16086 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
16087 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
16088 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
16089 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
16090 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
16091 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
16092 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
16093 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016094
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016095dst_is_local : boolean
16096 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
16097 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
16098 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
16099 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016100 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016101 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
16102 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
16103 it only once per connection.
16104
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016105dst_port : integer
16106 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
16107 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
16108 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
16109 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
16110 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
16111 an HTTP header.
16112
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020016113fc_http_major : integer
16114 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
16115 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
16116 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
16117
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020016118fc_pp_authority : string
16119 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
16120 if any.
16121
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010016122fc_pp_unique_id : string
16123 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
16124 if any.
16125
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010016126fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
16127 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
16128 header.
16129
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020016130fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
16131 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
16132 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
16133 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
16134 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
16135 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
16136 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16137
16138fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
16139 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
16140 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
16141 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
16142 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
16143 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
16144 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16145
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016146fc_unacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016147 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
16148 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
16149 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
16150 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16151
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016152fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016153 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
16154 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
16155 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
16156 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16157
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016158fc_retrans : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016159 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
16160 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16161 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16162 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16163
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016164fc_fackets : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016165 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
16166 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16167 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16168 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16169
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016170fc_lost : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016171 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
16172 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16173 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16174 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16175
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020016176fc_reordering : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070016177 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
16178 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
16179 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
16180 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
16181
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020016182fe_defbe : string
16183 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
16184 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
16185
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016186fe_id : integer
16187 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010016188 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016189 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
16190
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010016191fe_name : string
16192 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
16193 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
16194 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
16195
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016196sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016197sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
16198sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
16199sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016200 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
16201 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
16202 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
16203
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016204sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016205sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
16206sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
16207sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016208 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
16209 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
16210 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
16211
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016212sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016213sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16214sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16215sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016216 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
16217 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010016218 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
16219 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
16220 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016221
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016222 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016223 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
16224 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016225 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
16226 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
16227 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016228 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
16229 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
16230
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016231sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16232sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16233sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16234sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16235 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
16236 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
16237 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
16238 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
16239 when a first ACL was verified.
16240
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016241sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016242sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16243sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16244sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016245 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016246 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
16247
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016248sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016249sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
16250sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
16251sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016252 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
16253 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
16254 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
16255
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016256sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016257sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
16258sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
16259sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016260 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
16261 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
16262 See also src_conn_rate.
16263
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016264sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016265sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16266sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16267sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016268 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016269 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016270
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016271sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16272sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16273sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16274sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16275 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
16276 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
16277
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020016278sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16279sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
16280sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
16281sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
16282 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
16283 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
16284
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016285sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016286sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
16287sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
16288sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016289 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
16290 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
16291 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016292 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
16293 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
16294 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016295
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016296sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16297sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
16298sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
16299sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
16300 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
16301 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
16302 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
16303 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
16304 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
16305 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
16306
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016307sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016308sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16309sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16310sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016311 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016312 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
16313 See also src_http_err_cnt.
16314
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016315sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016316sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
16317sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
16318sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016319 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
16320 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
16321 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
16322 src_http_err_rate.
16323
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016324sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016325sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16326sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16327sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016328 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016329 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
16330 src_http_req_cnt.
16331
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016332sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016333sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
16334sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
16335sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016336 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
16337 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
16338 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
16339 src_http_req_rate.
16340
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016341sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016342sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16343sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16344sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016345 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010016346 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
16347 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
16348 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
16349 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016350
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016351 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016352 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
16353 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016354 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
16355
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016356sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
16357sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16358sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16359sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16360 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
16361 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
16362 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
16363 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
16364 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
16365
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016366sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016367sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
16368sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
16369sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020016370 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
16371 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
16372 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016373
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016374sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016375sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
16376sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
16377sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020016378 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
16379 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
16380 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016381
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016382sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016383sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16384sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16385sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016386 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016387 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
16388 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
16389 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016390 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016391 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
16392
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016393sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016394sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
16395sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
16396sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016397 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
16398 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
16399 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
16400 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
16401 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016402 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016403
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016404sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016405sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
16406sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
16407sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020016408 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
16409 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
16410 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
16411
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020016412sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020016413sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
16414sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
16415sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010016416 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
16417 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016418 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010016419 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
16420 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016421 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
16422 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
16423 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010016424
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016425so_id : integer
16426 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
16427 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
16428 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016429
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010016430so_name : string
16431 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
16432 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
16433 strings instead of integers.
16434
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016435src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016436 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016437 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
16438 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
16439 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016440 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
16441 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
16442 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010016443 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
16444 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
16445 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
16446 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
16447 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
16448 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
16449 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016450
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016451 Example:
16452 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
16453 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
16454
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016455src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
16456 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
16457 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
16458 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016459 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016460
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016461src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
16462 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
16463 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016464 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016465 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016466
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016467src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16468 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
16469 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16470 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
16471 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
16472 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
16473 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016474
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016475 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016476 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
16477 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
16478 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
16479 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010016480 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020016481 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
16482 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
16483
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016484src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16485 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
16486 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16487 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
16488 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
16489 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
16490 was verified.
16491
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016492src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016493 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016494 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016495 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016496 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016497
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016498src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016499 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016500 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
16501 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016502 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016503
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016504src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
16505 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
16506 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
16507 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016508 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016509
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016510src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016511 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016512 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016513 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016514 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016515
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016516src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16517 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
16518 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
16519 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
16520 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
16521
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020016522src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
16523 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
16524 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
16525 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
16526 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
16527
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016528src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016529 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016530 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016531 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
16532 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016533 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
16534 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
16535 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020016536
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016537src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
16538 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
16539 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
16540 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
16541 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
16542 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
16543 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
16544 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
16545
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016546src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016547 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016548 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016549 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016550 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016551 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016552
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016553src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
16554 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
16555 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
16556 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
16557 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016558 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016559
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016560src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016561 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016562 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
16563 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016564 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016565
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016566src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
16567 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
16568 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
16569 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016570 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016571 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016572
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016573src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
16574 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
16575 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16576 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020016577 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016578 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
16579 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016580
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016581 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016582 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010016583 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020016584 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016585
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016586src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
16587 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
16588 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16589 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
16590 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
16591 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
16592 connection when a first ACL was verified.
16593
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016594src_is_local : boolean
16595 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
16596 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
16597 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
16598 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016599 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020016600 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
16601 once per connection.
16602
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016603src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020016604 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
16605 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
16606 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
16607 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
16608 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016609
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016610src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020016611 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
16612 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
16613 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
16614 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
16615 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020016616
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016617src_port : integer
16618 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
16619 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
16620 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
16621 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010016622
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016623src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016624 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016625 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
16626 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
16627 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016628 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016629
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016630src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
16631 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
16632 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
16633 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
16634 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020016635 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016636
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016637src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
16638 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
16639 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
16640 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
16641 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
16642 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
16643 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
16644 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
16645 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020016646
16647 Example :
16648 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
16649 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
16650 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
16651 listen ssh
16652 bind :22
16653 mode tcp
16654 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020016655 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016656 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020016657 server local 127.0.0.1:22
16658
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016659srv_id : integer
16660 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
16661 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020016662 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020016663
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080016664srv_name : string
16665 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
16666 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020016667 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080016668
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200166697.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016670----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020016671
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016672The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
16673closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
16674when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
16675usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016676future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020016677
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001667851d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
16679 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
16680 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
16681 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
16682 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
16683 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
16684
16685 Example :
16686 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
16687 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
16688 # the request.
16689 frontend http-in
16690 bind *:8081
16691 default_backend servers
16692 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
16693 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
16694
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016695ssl_bc : boolean
16696 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
16697 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016698 other a server with the "ssl" option. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
16699 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016700
16701ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
16702 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016703 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
16704 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016705
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010016706ssl_bc_alpn : string
16707 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
16708 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020016709 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010016710 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
16711 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
16712 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
16713 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
16714 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016715 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn". It can be used in a
16716 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010016717
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016718ssl_bc_cipher : string
16719 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016720 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
16721 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016722
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016723ssl_bc_client_random : binary
16724 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
16725 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
16726 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016727 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016728
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010016729ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
16730 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
16731 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016732 session or a TLS ticket. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
16733 ruleset.
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010016734
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010016735ssl_bc_npn : string
16736 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
16737 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020016738 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010016739 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
16740 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
16741 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
16742 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016743 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN. It can be used in a tcp-check
16744 or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010016745
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016746ssl_bc_protocol : string
16747 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016748 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
16749 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016750
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020016751ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016752 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020016753 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016754 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64". It
16755 can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016756
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016757ssl_bc_server_random : binary
16758 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
16759 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
16760 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016761 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040016762
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016763ssl_bc_session_id : binary
16764 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
16765 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016766 if session was reused or not. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
16767 ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016768
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040016769ssl_bc_session_key : binary
16770 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
16771 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
16772 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016773 BoringSSL. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040016774
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016775ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
16776 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020016777 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
16778 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020016779
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016780ssl_c_ca_err : integer
16781 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16782 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
16783 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
16784 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
16785 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020016786
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016787ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
16788 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16789 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
16790 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
16791 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016792
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010016793ssl_c_der : binary
16794 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
16795 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
16796 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
16797
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016798ssl_c_err : integer
16799 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16800 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
16801 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
16802 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
16803 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016804
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016805ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016806 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16807 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
16808 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
16809 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
16810 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
16811 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
16812 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
16813 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016814 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
16815 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
16816 LDAP v3.
16817 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
16818 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016819
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016820ssl_c_key_alg : string
16821 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
16822 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
16823 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016824
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016825ssl_c_notafter : string
16826 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
16827 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
16828 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020016829
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016830ssl_c_notbefore : string
16831 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
16832 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
16833 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010016834
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016835ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016836 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16837 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
16838 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
16839 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
16840 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
16841 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
16842 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
16843 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016844 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
16845 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
16846 LDAP v3.
16847 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
16848 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010016849
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016850ssl_c_serial : binary
16851 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
16852 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
16853 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016854
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016855ssl_c_sha1 : binary
16856 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
16857 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
16858 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020016859 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
16860 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
16861
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030016862 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020016863 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016864
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016865ssl_c_sig_alg : string
16866 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
16867 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
16868 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020016869
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016870ssl_c_used : boolean
16871 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
16872 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020016873
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016874ssl_c_verify : integer
16875 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
16876 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
16877 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
16878 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020016879
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016880ssl_c_version : integer
16881 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
16882 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020016883
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010016884ssl_f_der : binary
16885 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
16886 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
16887 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
16888
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016889ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016890 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16891 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
16892 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
16893 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020016894 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016895 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
16896 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
16897 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016898 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
16899 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
16900 LDAP v3.
16901 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
16902 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020016903
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016904ssl_f_key_alg : string
16905 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
16906 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
16907 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020016908
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016909ssl_f_notafter : string
16910 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
16911 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
16912 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016913
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016914ssl_f_notbefore : string
16915 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
16916 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
16917 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020016918
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016919ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016920 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
16921 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
16922 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
16923 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
16924 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
16925 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
16926 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
16927 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050016928 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
16929 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
16930 LDAP v3.
16931 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
16932 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020016933
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016934ssl_f_serial : binary
16935 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
16936 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
16937 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020016938
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020016939ssl_f_sha1 : binary
16940 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
16941 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
16942 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
16943
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016944ssl_f_sig_alg : string
16945 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
16946 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
16947 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020016948
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016949ssl_f_version : integer
16950 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
16951 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
16952
16953ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020016954 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
16955 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
16956 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
16957
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016958 Example :
16959 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
16960 listen http-https
16961 bind :80
16962 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
16963 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
16964
16965ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
16966 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
16967 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
16968
16969ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016970 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016971 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
16972 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
16973 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
16974 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
16975 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
16976 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
16977 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
16978 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
16979
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016980ssl_fc_cipher : string
16981 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
16982 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020016983
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016984ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
16985 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
16986 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010016987 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016988
16989ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
16990 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
16991 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010016992 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010016993
16994ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
16995 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
16996 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
16997 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016998 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020016999 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017000
17001ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
17002 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
17003 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010017004 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010017005
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017006ssl_fc_client_random : binary
17007 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
17008 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
17009 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
17010
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017011ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017012 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
17013 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010017014 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
17015 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
17016 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
17017 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020017018
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020017019ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
17020 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
17021 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
17022 wait until the handshake happened.
17023
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017024ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
17025 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020017026 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
17027 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017028 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020017029 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020017030
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020017031ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020017032 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010017033 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
17034 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020017035
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017036ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017037 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017038 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
17039 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
17040 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
17041 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
17042 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
17043 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
17044 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020017045
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017046ssl_fc_protocol : string
17047 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
17048 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020017049
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017050ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040017051 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020017052 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
17053 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040017054
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040017055ssl_fc_server_random : binary
17056 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
17057 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
17058 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
17059
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017060ssl_fc_session_id : binary
17061 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
17062 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
17063 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
17064 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020017065
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040017066ssl_fc_session_key : binary
17067 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
17068 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
17069 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
17070 BoringSSL.
17071
17072
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017073ssl_fc_sni : string
17074 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
17075 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
17076 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
17077 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
17078 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
17079
17080 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
17081 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
17082 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017083 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020017084 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017085
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017086 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017087 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
17088 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020017089
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017090ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
17091 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
17092 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020017093
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020017094ssl_s_der : binary
17095 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the server when the
17096 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17097 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
17098
17099ssl_s_key_alg : string
17100 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
17101 presented by the server when the outgoing connection was made over an
17102 SSL/TLS transport layer.
17103
17104ssl_s_notafter : string
17105 Returns the end date presented by the server as a formatted string
17106 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17107 transport layer.
17108
17109ssl_s_notbefore : string
17110 Returns the start date presented by the server as a formatted string
17111 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
17112 transport layer.
17113
17114ssl_s_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
17115 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17116 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
17117 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17118 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17119 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17120 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020017121 For instance, "ssl_s_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17122 "ssl_s_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020017123 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17124 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17125 LDAP v3.
17126 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17127 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
17128
17129ssl_s_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
17130 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
17131 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
17132 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
17133 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
17134 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
17135 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020017136 For instance, "ssl_s_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
17137 "ssl_s_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020017138 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
17139 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
17140 LDAP v3.
17141 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
17142 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
17143
17144ssl_s_serial : binary
17145 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the server when the
17146 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
17147 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
17148
17149ssl_s_sha1 : binary
17150 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the server
17151 when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
17152 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
17153
17154ssl_s_sig_alg : string
17155 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
17156 the server when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
17157 layer.
17158
17159ssl_s_version : integer
17160 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the server when the
17161 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020017162
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200171637.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017164------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020017165
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017166Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
17167sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
17168only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
17169For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
17170be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
17171can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
17172sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
17173for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
17174content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017175
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017176payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017177 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017178 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
17179 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017180
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017181payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
17182 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017183 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017184 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017185
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020017186req.hdrs : string
17187 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
17188 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
17189 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
17190 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
17191
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020017192req.hdrs_bin : binary
17193 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
17194 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
17195 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
17196 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
17197 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
17198 names and values (length of 0 for both).
17199
17200 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
17201
17202 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
17203 str: <int:length><bytes>
17204
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017205req.len : integer
17206req_len : integer (deprecated)
17207 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
17208 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
17209 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
17210 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
17211 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
17212 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
17213 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
17214 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017215
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017216req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
17217 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020017218 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
17219 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
17220 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
17221 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017222
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017223 ACL alternatives :
17224 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017225
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017226req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
17227 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
17228 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
17229 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
17230 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017231
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017232 ACL alternatives :
17233 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017234
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017235 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017236
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017237req.proto_http : boolean
17238req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
17239 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
17240 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
17241 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
17242 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
17243 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
17244 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
17245 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017246
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017247 Example:
17248 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
17249 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
17250 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017251 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020017252
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017253req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
17254rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
17255 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
17256 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
17257 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
17258 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
17259 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
17260 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
17261 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017262
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017263 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
17264 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
17265 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
17266 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
17267 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
17268 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017269
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017270 ACL derivatives :
17271 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017272
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017273 Example :
17274 listen tse-farm
17275 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
17276 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
17277 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
17278 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
17279 # apply RDP cookie persistence
17280 persist rdp-cookie
17281 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
17282 # This is only useful makes sense if
17283 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
17284 stick-table type string size 204800
17285 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
17286 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
17287 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017288
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017289 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
17290 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017291
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017292req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
17293rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
17294 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
17295 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
17296 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
17297 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017298
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017299 ACL derivatives :
17300 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017301
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110017302req.ssl_alpn : string
17303 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
17304 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
17305 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
17306 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
17307 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
17308 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020017309 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110017310
17311 Examples :
17312 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
17313 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
17314 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020017315 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110017316 default_backend bk_default
17317
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020017318req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
17319 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
17320 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020017321 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
17322 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
17323 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
17324 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
17325 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020017326
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017327req.ssl_hello_type : integer
17328req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
17329 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
17330 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
17331 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
17332 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
17333 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
17334 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
17335 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017336
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017337req.ssl_sni : string
17338req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
17339 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
17340 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
17341 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
17342 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
17343 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
17344 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
17345 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
17346 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
17347 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
17348 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
17349 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
17350 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017351
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017352 ACL derivatives :
17353 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017354
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017355 Examples :
17356 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
17357 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
17358 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
17359 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
17360 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020017361
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053017362req.ssl_st_ext : integer
17363 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
17364 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
17365 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
17366 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
17367 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
17368 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
17369 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
17370 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
17371 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
17372
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017373req.ssl_ver : integer
17374req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
17375 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
17376 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
17377 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
17378 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
17379 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
17380 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
17381 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017382 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017383 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017384
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017385 ACL derivatives :
17386 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017387
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020017388res.len : integer
17389 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
17390 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
17391 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
17392 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
17393 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
17394 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
17395 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017396 content inspection. But it may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020017397
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017398res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
17399 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020017400 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017401 the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020017402 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017403 any location. It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017404
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017405res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
17406 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
17407 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
17408 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017409 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign. It may also be used in tcp-check based
17410 expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017411
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017412 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017413
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020017414res.ssl_hello_type : integer
17415rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
17416 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
17417 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
17418 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
17419 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
17420 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
17421 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
17422 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
17423
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017424wait_end : boolean
17425 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
17426 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017427 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017428 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
17429 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017430 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017431 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
17432 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017433
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017434 Examples :
17435 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
17436 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
17437 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017438
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017439 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
17440 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
17441 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
17442 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
17443 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
17444 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
17445 tcp-request content reject
17446
17447
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200174487.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017449--------------------------------------
17450
17451It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
17452This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
17453data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
17454its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
17455HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
17456content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
17457to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
17458more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
17459response are indexed.
17460
17461base : string
17462 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
17463 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
17464 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
17465 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
17466 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
17467 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
17468 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
17469 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
17470
17471 ACL derivatives :
17472 base : exact string match
17473 base_beg : prefix match
17474 base_dir : subdir match
17475 base_dom : domain match
17476 base_end : suffix match
17477 base_len : length match
17478 base_reg : regex match
17479 base_sub : substring match
17480
17481base32 : integer
17482 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
17483 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
17484 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017485 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
17486 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
17487 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017488
17489base32+src : binary
17490 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
17491 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
17492 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
17493 per-URL counters.
17494
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010017495capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
17496 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
17497 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
17498 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
17499
17500capture.req.method : string
17501 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
17502 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
17503 because it's allocated.
17504
17505capture.req.uri : string
17506 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
17507 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
17508 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
17509 allocated.
17510
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020017511capture.req.ver : string
17512 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
17513 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
17514 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
17515
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010017516capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
17517 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
17518 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
17519 The first entry is an index of 0.
17520 See also: "capture response header"
17521
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020017522capture.res.ver : string
17523 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
17524 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
17525 persistent flag.
17526
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020017527req.body : binary
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020017528 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It is
17529 recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as much
17530 as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020017531
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020017532req.body_param([<name>) : string
17533 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
17534 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
17535 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
17536 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
17537 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
17538 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
17539 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
17540 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
17541 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
17542 given.
17543
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020017544req.body_len : integer
17545 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
17546 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020017547 is recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as
17548 much as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020017549
17550req.body_size : integer
17551 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020017552 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
17553 available data in case of chunked encoding.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020017554
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017555req.cook([<name>]) : string
17556cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
17557 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
17558 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
17559 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
17560 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
17561 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
17562 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
17563 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
17564 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
17565
17566 ACL derivatives :
17567 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
17568 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
17569 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
17570 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
17571 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
17572 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
17573 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
17574 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017575
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017576req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17577cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
17578 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
17579 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017580
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017581req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
17582cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
17583 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
17584 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
17585 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
17586 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020017587
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017588cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
17589 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
17590 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
17591 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
17592 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020017593 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017594 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
17595 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
17596 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
17597 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017598
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017599hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
17600 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
17601 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
17602 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
17603 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017604 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017605
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017606req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
17607 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
17608 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
17609 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
17610 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
17611 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
17612 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
17613 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
17614 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017615
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017616req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17617 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
17618 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
17619 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
17620 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017621
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017622req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
17623 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
17624 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
17625 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
17626 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
17627 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
17628 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
17629 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
17630 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000017631 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017632 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017633 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017634
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017635 ACL derivatives :
17636 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
17637 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
17638 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
17639 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
17640 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
17641 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
17642 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
17643 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
17644
17645req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17646hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
17647 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
17648 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
17649 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
17650 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
17651 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
17652 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
17653 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
17654 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
17655 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
17656
17657req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
17658hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
17659 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
17660 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
17661 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
17662 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
17663 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017664 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017665 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
17666 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
17667
17668req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
17669hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
17670 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
17671 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
17672 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
17673 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
17674 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
17675 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
17676 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
17677
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010017678
17679
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017680http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
17681 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
17682 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
17683 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
17684 basic auth is supported.
17685
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010017686http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
17687 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
17688 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
17689 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
17690 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017691 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
17692 basic auth is supported.
17693
17694 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010017695 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
17696 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
17697 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
17698 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017699
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020017700http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010017701 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
17702 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
17703 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020017704
17705http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010017706 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
17707 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
17708 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020017709
17710http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010017711 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
17712 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
17713 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020017714
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017715http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020017716 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
17717 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017718 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
17719 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020017720
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017721method : integer + string
17722 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
17723 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
17724 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
17725 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
17726 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
17727 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
17728 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017729
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017730 ACL derivatives :
17731 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017732
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017733 Example :
17734 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
17735 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
17736 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017737
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017738path : string
17739 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
17740 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
17741 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
17742 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
17743 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017744 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017745 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017746
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017747 ACL derivatives :
17748 path : exact string match
17749 path_beg : prefix match
17750 path_dir : subdir match
17751 path_dom : domain match
17752 path_end : suffix match
17753 path_len : length match
17754 path_reg : regex match
17755 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017756
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010017757query : string
17758 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
17759 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
17760 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
17761 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010017762 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010017763 which stops before the question mark.
17764
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010017765req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
17766 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
17767 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
17768 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
17769 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
17770
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017771req.ver : string
17772req_ver : string (deprecated)
17773 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
17774 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
17775 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017776
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017777 ACL derivatives :
17778 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020017779
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017780res.body : binary
17781 This returns the HTTP response's available body as a block of data. Unlike
17782 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
17783 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context. It
17784 may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
17785
17786res.body_len : integer
17787 This returns the length of the HTTP response available body in bytes. Unlike
17788 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
17789 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context. It
17790 may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
17791
17792res.body_size : integer
17793 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP response body in bytes. It
17794 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
17795 available data in case of chunked encoding. Unlike the request side, there is
17796 no directive to wait for the response body. This sample fetch is really
17797 useful (and usable) in the health-check context. It may be used in tcp-check
17798 based expect rules.
17799
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017800res.comp : boolean
17801 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
17802 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
17803 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017804
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017805res.comp_algo : string
17806 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
17807 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
17808 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017809
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017810res.cook([<name>]) : string
17811scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
17812 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
17813 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017814 specified, the first cookie value is returned. It may be used in tcp-check
17815 based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020017816
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017817 ACL derivatives :
17818 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020017819
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017820res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17821scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
17822 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
17823 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017824 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses. It may
17825 be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017826
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017827res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
17828scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
17829 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
17830 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017831 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. It may
17832 be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017833
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017834res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
17835 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
17836 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
17837 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
17838 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
17839 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
17840 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
17841 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
17842 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017843 Expires. It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017844
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017845res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17846 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
17847 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
17848 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
17849 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017850 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead. It may be used in
17851 tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017852
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017853res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
17854shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
17855 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
17856 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
17857 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
17858 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
17859 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
17860 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
17861 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017862 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead. It may be used in tcp-check based
17863 expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017864
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017865 ACL derivatives :
17866 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
17867 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
17868 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
17869 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
17870 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
17871 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
17872 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
17873 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
17874
17875res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
17876shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
17877 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
17878 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
17879 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
17880 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017881 instead. It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017882
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017883res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
17884shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
17885 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
17886 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
17887 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
17888 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
17889 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017890 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table. It
17891 may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017892
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010017893res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
17894 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
17895 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
17896 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017897 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered. It may be used
17898 in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010017899
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017900res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
17901shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
17902 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
17903 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
17904 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
17905 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
17906 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017907 useful to learn some data into a stick table. It may be used in tcp-check
17908 based expect rules.
17909
17910res.hdrs : string
17911 Returns the current response headers as string including the last empty line
17912 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
17913 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
17914 headers analyzers and for advanced logging. It may also be used in tcp-check
17915 based expect rules.
17916
17917res.hdrs_bin : binary
17918 Returns the current response headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
17919 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. It may be used in
17920 tcp-check based expect rules. Each string is described by a length followed
17921 by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The length is represented
17922 using the variable integer encoding detailed in the SPOE documentation. The
17923 end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header names and values
17924 (length of 0 for both).
17925
17926 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
17927
17928 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
17929 str: <int:length><bytes>
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010017930
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017931res.ver : string
17932resp_ver : string (deprecated)
17933 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017934 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. It may be used in
17935 tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020017936
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017937 ACL derivatives :
17938 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010017939
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017940set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
17941 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
17942 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020017943 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017944 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010017945
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017946 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
17947 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010017948
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017949status : integer
17950 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
17951 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020017952 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx. It may be used in
17953 tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017954
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020017955unique-id : string
17956 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
17957 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
17958 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
17959 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
17960 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
17961 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
17962
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017963url : string
17964 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
17965 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
17966 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
17967 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
17968 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
17969 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
17970 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017971
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017972 ACL derivatives :
17973 url : exact string match
17974 url_beg : prefix match
17975 url_dir : subdir match
17976 url_dom : domain match
17977 url_end : suffix match
17978 url_len : length match
17979 url_reg : regex match
17980 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017981
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017982url_ip : ip
17983 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
17984 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
17985 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
17986 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
17987 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
17988 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
17989 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017990
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017991url_port : integer
17992 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
17993 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
17994 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
17995 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020017996
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020017997urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
17998url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017999 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
18000 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020018001 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
18002 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
18003 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
18004 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018005 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
18006 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020018007 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
18008 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018009
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018010 ACL derivatives :
18011 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
18012 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
18013 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
18014 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
18015 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
18016 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
18017 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
18018 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018019
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018020
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018021 Example :
18022 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
18023 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
18024 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
18025 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020018026
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018027urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018028 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
18029 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
18030 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020018031
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020018032url32 : integer
18033 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
18034 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
18035 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
18036 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
18037 is an unsigned integer.
18038
18039url32+src : binary
18040 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
18041 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
18042 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
18043
Christopher Faulet16032ab2020-04-30 11:30:00 +020018044
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200180457.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018046---------------------------------------
18047
18048This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
18049used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
18050purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
18051There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
18052or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
18053any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
18054for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
18055
18056internal.htx.data : integer
18057 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
18058 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18059
18060internal.htx.free : integer
18061 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
18062 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18063
18064internal.htx.free_data : integer
18065 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
18066 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18067
18068internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
18069 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains an
18070 end-of-message block (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is
18071 chosen depending on the sample direction.
18072
18073internal.htx.nbblks : integer
18074 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
18075 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18076
18077internal.htx.size : integer
18078 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
18079 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18080
18081internal.htx.used : integer
18082 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
18083 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18084 direction.
18085
18086internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
18087 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
18088 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
18089 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
18090 of the special value :
18091 * head : The oldest inserted block
18092 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018093 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018094
18095internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
18096 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
18097 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
18098 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
18099 integer or one of the special value :
18100 * head : The oldest inserted block
18101 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018102 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018103
18104internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
18105 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
18106 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
18107 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
18108 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18109
18110 * head : The oldest inserted block
18111 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018112 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018113
18114internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
18115 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
18116 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
18117 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18118 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18119
18120 * head : The oldest inserted block
18121 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018122 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018123
18124internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
18125 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
18126 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
18127 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18128 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18129
18130 * head : The oldest inserted block
18131 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018132 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018133
18134internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
18135 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
18136 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
18137 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
18138 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
18139
18140 * head : The oldest inserted block
18141 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050018142 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010018143
18144internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
18145 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
18146 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
18147 it returns false.
18148
18149
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200181507.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018151---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010018152
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018153Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
18154every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020018155order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010018156
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018157ACL name Equivalent to Usage
18158---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018159FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020018160HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018161HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
18162HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018163HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
18164HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
18165HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
18166HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
18167LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018168METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020018169METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018170METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
18171METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
18172METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
18173METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020018174METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018175METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020018176RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018177REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018178TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018179WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
18180---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010018181
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010018182
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200181838. Logging
18184----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010018185
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018186One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
18187provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
18188very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
18189provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
18190state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010018191to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018192headers.
18193
18194In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
18195about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
18196send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
18197
18198 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
18199 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
18200 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
18201 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
18202 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018203 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060018204 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018205
18206The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
18207allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
18208as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
18209while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
18210real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
18211delay.
18212
18213
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200182148.1. Log levels
18215---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018216
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090018217TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018218source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090018219HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
18220in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
18221track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
18222syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
18223about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018224
18225
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200182268.2. Log formats
18227----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018228
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018229HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090018230and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
18231slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
18232options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018233
18234 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
18235 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
18236 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
18237 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
18238 extents.
18239
18240 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
18241 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
18242 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
18243 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
18244 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
18245
18246 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
18247 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
18248 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
18249 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
18250 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
18251
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020018252 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
18253 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
18254 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
18255 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
18256
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018257 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
18258
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018259Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
18260specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
18261field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
18262servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
18263always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
18264identifier.
18265
18266Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
18267 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
18268 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
18269 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
18270 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
18271
18272
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200182738.2.1. Default log format
18274-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018275
18276This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
18277as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
18278format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
18279
18280 Example :
18281 listen www
18282 mode http
18283 log global
18284 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
18285
18286 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
18287 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
18288 (www/HTTP)
18289
18290 Field Format Extract from the example above
18291 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
18292 2 'Connect from' Connect from
18293 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
18294 4 'to' to
18295 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
18296 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
18297
18298Detailed fields description :
18299 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
18300 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
18301 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
18302 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
18303 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
18304 and processed the connection.
18305 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
18306
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010018307In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
18308"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
18309connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
18310
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018311It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
18312will eventually disappear.
18313
18314
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200183158.2.2. TCP log format
18316---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018317
18318The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
18319is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
18320information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
18321counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
18322emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
18323environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
18324the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
18325sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020018326specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
18327not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
18328fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
18329marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018330
18331 Example :
18332 frontend fnt
18333 mode tcp
18334 option tcplog
18335 log global
18336 default_backend bck
18337
18338 backend bck
18339 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
18340
18341 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
18342 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
18343 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
18344
18345 Field Format Extract from the example above
18346 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
18347 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
18348 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
18349 4 frontend_name fnt
18350 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
18351 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
18352 7 bytes_read* 212
18353 8 termination_state --
18354 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
18355 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
18356
18357Detailed fields description :
18358 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010018359 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
18360 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
18361 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018362 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018363 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018364 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018365
18366 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010018367 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
18368 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
18369 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018370
18371 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
18372 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
18373 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018374 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
18375 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
18376 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
18377 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018378
18379 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
18380 and processed the connection.
18381
18382 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
18383 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
18384 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
18385 applications.
18386
18387 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
18388 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
18389 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
18390 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
18391 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
18392
18393 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
18394 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
18395 See "Timers" below for more details.
18396
18397 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
18398 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
18399 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
18400 "Timers" below for more details.
18401
18402 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018403 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018404 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
18405 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
18406 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
18407 details.
18408
18409 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
18410 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
18411 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
18412 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
18413 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
18414
18415 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
18416 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
18417 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
18418 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
18419 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
18420 for more details.
18421
18422 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018423 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018424 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
18425 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
18426 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018427 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018428
18429 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
18430 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
18431 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
18432 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
18433 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
18434 caused by a denial of service attack.
18435
18436 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
18437 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
18438 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
18439 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
18440 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
18441 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
18442 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
18443 denial of service attack.
18444
18445 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
18446 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
18447 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
18448 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
18449 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
18450 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
18451 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
18452 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
18453 be processed than on other servers.
18454
18455 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
18456 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
18457 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
18458 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
18459 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
18460 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
18461 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
18462 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
18463 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
18464 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
18465 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
18466 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
18467 should not be attributed to the logged server.
18468
18469 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
18470 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
18471 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
18472 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
18473 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
18474 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018475 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018476 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
18477
18478 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
18479 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
18480 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
18481 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
18482 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
18483 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018484 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018485 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
18486 occurs.
18487
18488
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200184898.2.3. HTTP log format
18490----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018491
18492The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
18493is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
18494the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
18495are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
18496emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
18497generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
18498"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
18499which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020018500frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
18501is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018502
18503Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
18504slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
18505with a star ('*') after the field name below.
18506
18507 Example :
18508 frontend http-in
18509 mode http
18510 option httplog
18511 log global
18512 default_backend bck
18513
18514 backend static
18515 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
18516
18517 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
18518 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
18519 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018520 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018521
18522 Field Format Extract from the example above
18523 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
18524 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018525 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018526 4 frontend_name http-in
18527 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018528 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018529 7 status_code 200
18530 8 bytes_read* 2750
18531 9 captured_request_cookie -
18532 10 captured_response_cookie -
18533 11 termination_state ----
18534 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
18535 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
18536 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
18537 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
18538 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010018539
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018540Detailed fields description :
18541 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010018542 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
18543 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
18544 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018545 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018546 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018547 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018548
18549 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010018550 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
18551 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
18552 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018553
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018554 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
18555 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018556
18557 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
18558 and processed the connection.
18559
18560 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
18561 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
18562 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
18563
18564 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
18565 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
18566 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
18567 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
18568 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
18569 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
18570
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018571 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
18572 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
18573 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018574 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018575 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
18576 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018577 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
18578 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018579
18580 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
18581 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018582 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018583
18584 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
18585 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018586 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
18587 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018588
18589 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
18590 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
18591 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
18592 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
18593 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018594 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
18595 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018596
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018597 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
18598 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
18599 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
18600 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
18601 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
18602 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
18603 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020018604 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018605
18606 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
18607 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
18608 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
18609
18610 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
18611 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018612 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018613 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
18614 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
18615 overflowing.
18616
18617 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
18618 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
18619 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
18620 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
18621 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
18622 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
18623 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
18624 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
18625
18626 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
18627 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
18628 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
18629 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
18630 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
18631 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
18632 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
18633 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
18634
18635 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
18636 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
18637 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
18638 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
18639 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
18640 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
18641 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
18642
18643 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018644 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018645 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
18646 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
18647 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018648 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018649 system.
18650
18651 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
18652 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
18653 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
18654 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
18655 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
18656 caused by a denial of service attack.
18657
18658 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
18659 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
18660 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
18661 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
18662 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
18663 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
18664 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
18665 denial of service attack.
18666
18667 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
18668 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
18669 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
18670 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
18671 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
18672 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
18673 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
18674 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
18675 processed than on other servers.
18676
18677 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
18678 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
18679 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
18680 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
18681 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
18682 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
18683 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
18684 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
18685 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
18686 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
18687 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
18688 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
18689 should not be attributed to the logged server.
18690
18691 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
18692 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
18693 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
18694 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
18695 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
18696 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018697 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018698 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
18699
18700 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
18701 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
18702 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
18703 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
18704 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
18705 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018706 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018707 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
18708 occurs.
18709
18710 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
18711 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
18712 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
18713 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
18714 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
18715 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
18716 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
18717 cookies" below for more details.
18718
18719 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
18720 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
18721 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
18722 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
18723 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
18724 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
18725 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
18726 and cookies" below for more details.
18727
18728 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
18729 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
18730 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
18731 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
18732 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
18733 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
18734 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
18735 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
18736
18737
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200187388.2.4. Custom log format
18739------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018740
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018741The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018742mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018743
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018744HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018745Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
18746separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
18747prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
18748
18749Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
18750variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010018751("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018752
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010018753If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020018754as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010018755less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
18756the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
18757
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018758Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018759In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010018760in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018761
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010018762Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
18763'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
18764https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
18765such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
18766
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018767Flags are :
18768 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018769 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010018770 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
18771 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018772
18773 Example:
18774
18775 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
18776 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
18777
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010018778 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
18779
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018780At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
18781
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018782 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
18783 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018784
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018785the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018786
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018787 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
18788 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
18789 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018790
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018791and the default TCP format is defined this way :
18792
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018793 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
18794 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018795
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018796Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
18797
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018798 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020018799 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018800 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
18801 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
18802 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018803 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
18804 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
18805 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020018806 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000018807 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
18808 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000018809 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000018810 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
18811 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010018812 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020018813 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020018814 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018815 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018816 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020018817 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080018818 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018819 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
18820 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
18821 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
18822 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
18823 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020018824 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018825 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000018826 | | %Tu | Tu | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018827 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018828 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018829 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
18830 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018831 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
18832 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
18833 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018834 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018835 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
18836 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018837 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018838 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
18839 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
18840 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020018841 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020018842 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020018843 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
18844 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
18845 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
18846 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020018847 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020018848 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020018849 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018850 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010018851 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018852 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018853 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
18854 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
18855 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018856 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020018857 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
18858 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010018859 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018860 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
18861 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020018862 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018863 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020018864 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010018865 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018866
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020018867 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010018868
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010018869
188708.2.5. Error log format
18871-----------------------
18872
18873When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
18874protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
18875By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
18876"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018877will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010018878logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
18879
18880The format looks like this :
18881
18882 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
18883 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
18884 Connection error during SSL handshake
18885
18886 Field Format Extract from the example above
18887 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
18888 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
18889 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
18890 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
18891 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
18892
18893These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
18894failures.
18895
18896
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200188978.3. Advanced logging options
18898-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018899
18900Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
18901just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
18902options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
18903for more information about their usage.
18904
18905
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200189068.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
18907------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018908
18909It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
18910haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
18911commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
18912monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
18913ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
18914
18915 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
18916 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
18917 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
18918 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
18919
18920 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
18921 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
18922 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018923 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018924 such as other load-balancers.
18925
18926 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
18927 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
18928 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
18929
18930
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200189318.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
18932----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018933
18934The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
18935what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
18936or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018937"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018938just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
18939log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
18940after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
18941is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
18942with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
18943with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
18944
18945
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200189468.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
18947------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020018948
18949Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
18950for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
18951"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
18952retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
18953raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
18954a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
18955file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
18956you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
18957"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
18958
18959
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200189608.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
18961--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020018962
18963Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
18964multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
18965them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
18966"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
18967logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
18968error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
18969and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
18970too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
18971useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
18972alternative.
18973
18974
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200189758.4. Timing events
18976------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010018977
18978Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
18979reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
18980the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
18981frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020018982mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
18983addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
18984
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010018985Timings events in HTTP mode:
18986
18987 first request 2nd request
18988 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
18989 t tr t tr ...
18990 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
18991 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
18992 :<---- Tq ---->: :
18993 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000018994 :<-- -----Tu--------------->:
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010018995 :<--------- Ta --------->:
18996
18997Timings events in TCP mode:
18998
18999 TCP session
19000 |<----------------->|
19001 t t
19002 ---|----|----|----|----|---
19003 | Th Tw Tc Td |
19004 |<------ Tt ------->|
19005
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019006 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019007 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019008 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
19009 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
19010 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019011 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019012 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
19013 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
19014 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
19015 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019016
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019017 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
19018 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
19019 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019020 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
19021 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
19022 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
19023 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
19024 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
19025 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019026
19027 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
19028 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
19029 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
19030 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
19031 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
19032 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
19033 request typed by hand during a test.
19034
19035 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
19036 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019037 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019038 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
19039 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
19040 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
19041 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019042
19043 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
19044 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
19045 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
19046 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
19047 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
19048
19049 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
19050 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
19051 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
19052 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
19053 connection never established.
19054
19055 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
19056 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
19057 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
19058 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
19059 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
19060 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
19061 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
19062 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
19063 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
19064 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
19065 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
19066
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019067 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
19068 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
19069 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
19070 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
19071 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
19072 by subtracting other timers when valid :
19073
19074 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
19075
19076 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
19077 "Ta" can never be negative.
19078
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019079 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
19080 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019081 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
19082 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019083 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019084
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019085 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019086
19087 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019088 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
19089 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019090
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000019091 - Tu: total estimated time as seen from client, between the moment the proxy
19092 accepted it and the moment both ends were closed, without idle time.
19093 This is useful to roughly measure end-to-end time as a user would see it,
19094 without idle time pollution from keep-alive time between requests. This
19095 timer in only an estimation of time seen by user as it assumes network
19096 latency is the same in both directions. The exception is when the "logasap"
19097 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
19098 prefixed with a '+' sign.
19099
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019100These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
19101protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
19102that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019103due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
19104"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
19105that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019106
19107Most common cases :
19108
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019109 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
19110 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
19111 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
19112 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
19113 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
19114 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
19115 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
19116 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
19117 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
19118 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
19119 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020019120 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019121
19122 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
19123 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
19124 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
19125 of ms on remote networks.
19126
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020019127 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
19128 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
19129 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019130
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019131 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
19132 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
19133 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
19134 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
19135 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
19136 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
19137 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
19138 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
19139 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019140
19141Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
19142
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019143 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019144 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019145 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019146
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019147 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019148 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
19149 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
19150
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019151 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019152 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
19153 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
19154 flags.
19155
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019156 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
19157 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019158 Check the session termination flags, then check the
19159 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
19160 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
19161 the client connection was maintained open.
19162
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019163 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019164 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019165 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019166 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
19167
19168
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200191698.5. Session state at disconnection
19170-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019171
19172TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
19173"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
191742-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
19175each of which has a special meaning :
19176
19177 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
19178 session to terminate :
19179
19180 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
19181
19182 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
19183 server explicitly refused it.
19184
19185 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
19186 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
19187 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
19188 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019189 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020019190
19191 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
19192 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019193
19194 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
19195 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
19196 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
19197 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
19198 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
19199
19200 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
19201 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
19202 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
19203 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
19204 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
19205
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090019206 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
19207 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
19208
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070019209 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
19210 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
19211 backup connections when going up.
19212
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020019213 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
19214
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019215 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
19216 send or receive data.
19217
19218 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
19219 send or receive data.
19220
19221 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
19222 with nothing left in the buffers.
19223
19224 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
19225
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010019226 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019227 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
19228
19229 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
19230 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
19231 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
19232 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
19233 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
19234
19235 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
19236 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
19237
19238 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
19239 server (HTTP only).
19240
19241 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
19242
19243 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
19244 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
19245 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
19246
19247 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
19248 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
19249 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
19250
19251 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
19252
19253 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
19254 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
19255
19256 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
19257 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
19258 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
19259
19260 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
19261 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020019262 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
19263 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019264
19265 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
19266 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
19267 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
19268 another server.
19269
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019270 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019271 server.
19272
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019273 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
19274 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
19275 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
19276 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
19277
19278 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
19279 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
19280 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
19281 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
19282
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020019283 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
19284 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
19285 "use-server" rule).
19286
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019287 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
19288
19289 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
19290 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
19291
19292 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
19293
19294 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
19295 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
19296 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
19297
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019298 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
19299 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019300 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019301 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
19302 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
19303
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019304 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
19305
19306 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
19307 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
19308
19309 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
19310
19311 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
19312
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019313The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
19314was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019315helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
19316starvation, attacks, etc...
19317
19318The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
19319alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
19320easier finding and understanding.
19321
19322 Flags Reason
19323
19324 -- Normal termination.
19325
19326 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
19327 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
19328 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
19329 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
19330
19331 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
19332 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
19333 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
19334 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
19335 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
19336 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019337
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019338 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
19339 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020019340 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019341
19342 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
19343 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
19344 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
19345
19346 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
19347 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
19348 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
19349 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
19350 the server takes too long to respond.
19351
19352 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
19353 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
19354 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
19355 long a time to respond.
19356
19357 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
19358 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
19359 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
19360 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020019361 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
19362 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019363
19364 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
19365 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
19366 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
19367 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
19368 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020019369 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020019370 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
19371 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
19372 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
19373 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
19374 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
19375 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
19376 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
19377 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019378 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020019379 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
19380 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
19381 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019382
19383 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
19384 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020019385 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
19386 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
19387 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
19388 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019389
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020019390 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
19391 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
19392
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010019393 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019394 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
19395 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019396 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019397 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
19398 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
19399
19400 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
19401 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
19402 503 or 504 here.
19403
19404 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
19405 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
19406 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
19407 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
19408 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
19409
19410 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
19411 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019412 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019413 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
19414 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
19415
19416 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
19417 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
19418 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
19419 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
19420 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
19421 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
19422 between haproxy and the server.
19423
19424 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
19425 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
19426 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
19427 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
19428 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
19429 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
19430 solution is to fix the application.
19431
19432 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
19433 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
19434 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
19435 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
19436 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
19437 external attacks.
19438
19439 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
19440 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020019441 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019442 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
19443 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
19444
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010019445 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
19446 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
19447 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019448 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020019449 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010019450
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019451 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
19452 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
19453 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
19454 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010019455 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
19456 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
19457 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
19458 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
19459 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019460
19461 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
19462 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
19463 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
19464 returned an HTTP 403 error.
19465
19466 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
19467 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
19468 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
19469 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
19470
19471 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
19472 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
19473 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
19474 only be solved by proper system tuning.
19475
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019476The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
19477persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
19478important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
19479re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
19480
19481 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
19482
19483 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
19484 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
19485 set on a GET request.
19486
19487 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
19488 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040019489 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020019490 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
19491
19492 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
19493 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
19494 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
19495
19496 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
19497 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
19498 already got a cookie.
19499
19500 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
19501 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
19502 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
19503 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
19504 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
19505
19506 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
19507 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
19508 new cookie was inserted in the response.
19509
19510 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
19511 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
19512 new cookie was inserted in the response.
19513
19514 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
19515 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
19516
19517 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
19518 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
19519 then advertised in the response.
19520
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019521
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200195228.6. Non-printable characters
19523-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019524
19525In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
19526consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
19527converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
19528prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
19529being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
19530escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
19531is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
19532'}' when logging headers.
19533
19534Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
19535issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
19536containing spaces is "User-Agent".
19537
19538Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
19539the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
19540performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
19541
19542
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200195438.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
19544---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019545
19546Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
19547achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019548section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019549cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
19550the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
19551the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019552locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019553not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
19554user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
19555a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
19556wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
19557
19558 Examples :
19559 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
19560 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
19561
19562 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
19563 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
19564
19565
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200195668.8. Capturing HTTP headers
19567---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019568
19569Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
19570proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
19571the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
19572server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
19573
19574Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
19575response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019576section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019577
19578It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010019579time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
19580appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019581are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
19582and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
19583follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
19584request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
19585in the logs.
19586
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020019587As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
19588frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
19589an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
19590
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019591 Example :
19592 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
19593 listen proxy-out
19594 mode http
19595 option httplog
19596 option logasap
19597 log global
19598 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
19599
19600 # log the name of the virtual server
19601 capture request header Host len 20
19602
19603 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
19604 capture request header Content-Length len 10
19605
19606 # log the beginning of the referrer
19607 capture request header Referer len 20
19608
19609 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
19610 capture response header Server len 20
19611
19612 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
19613 capture response header Content-Length len 10
19614
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019615 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019616 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
19617
19618 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
19619 capture response header Via len 20
19620
19621 # log the URL location during a redirection
19622 capture response header Location len 20
19623
19624 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
19625 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
19626 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
19627 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
19628 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
19629
19630 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
19631 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
19632 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
19633 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019634 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019635
19636 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
19637 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
19638 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
19639 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
19640 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019641 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019642
19643
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200196448.9. Examples of logs
19645---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019646
19647These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
19648them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
19649reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
19650
19651 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
19652 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
19653 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
19654
19655 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
19656 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
19657
19658 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
19659 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
19660 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
19661
19662 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
19663 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
19664
19665 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
19666 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
19667 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
19668
19669 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010019670 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019671 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
19672 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
19673
19674 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
19675 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
19676 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
19677
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020019678 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
19679 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
19680 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
19681 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
19682 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided to
19683 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019684
19685 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019686 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019687
19688 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
19689 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
19690 Nothing was sent to any server.
19691
19692 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
19693 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
19694
19695 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
19696 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019697 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019698 send a 408 return code to the client.
19699
19700 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
19701 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
19702
19703 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
19704 5 seconds ("c----").
19705
19706 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
19707 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019708 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019709
19710 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019711 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019712 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
19713 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
19714 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
19715 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
19716 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010019717
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020019718
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200197199. Supported filters
19720--------------------
19721
19722Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
19723accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
19724unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
19725
19726See also : "filter"
19727
197289.1. Trace
19729----------
19730
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010019731filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020019732
19733 Arguments:
19734 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
19735 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
19736
19737 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
19738 the client and the server. By default, this filter
19739 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
19740 only parses a random amount of the available data.
19741
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019742 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020019743 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
19744 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
19745 amount of the parsed data.
19746
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019747 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010019748
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020019749This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
19750callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
19751information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
19752filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
19753
19754Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
19755tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
19756a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
19757
19758
197599.2. HTTP compression
19760---------------------
19761
19762filter compression
19763
19764The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
19765keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019766when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
19767fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
19768done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
19769explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
19770filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
19771listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
19772order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020019773
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019774See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
19775 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020019776
19777
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200197789.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
19779--------------------------------------------
19780
19781filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
19782
19783 Arguments :
19784
19785 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
19786 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
19787 parsed.
19788
19789 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
19790 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
19791 part must be placed in its own scope.
19792
19793The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
19794external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019795streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020019796exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
19797also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
19798
19799SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
19800the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
19801
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010019802For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020019803"doc/SPOE.txt".
19804
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100198059.4. Cache
19806----------
19807
19808filter cache <name>
19809
19810 Arguments :
19811
19812 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
19813
19814The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
19815"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050019816cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019817other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
19818case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
19819is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
19820filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010019821listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
19822order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010019823
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019824See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
19825 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
19826
19827
198289.5. Fcgi-app
19829-------------
19830
19831filter fcg-app <name>
19832
19833 Arguments :
19834
19835 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
19836
19837The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
19838request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
19839reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
19840used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
19841implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
19842used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
19843fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
19844used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
19845order.
19846
19847See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
19848 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
19849
19850
1985110. FastCGI applications
19852-------------------------
19853
19854HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
19855feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
19856the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
19857FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
19858servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
19859FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
19860backend.
19861
19862HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
19863application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
19864connection.
19865
1986610.1. Setup
19867-----------
19868
1986910.1.1. Fcgi-app section
19870--------------------------
19871
19872fcgi-app <name>
19873 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
19874 document root must be defined.
19875
19876acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
19877 Declare or complete an access list.
19878
19879 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
19880 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
19881 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
19882 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
19883 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
19884
19885docroot <path>
19886 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
19887 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
19888 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
19889
19890index <script-name>
19891 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
19892 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
19893 is an optional setting.
19894
19895 Example :
19896 index index.php
19897
19898log-stderr global
19899log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
19900 [sample <ranges>:<smp_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
19901 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
19902
19903 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
19904 default STDERR messages are ignored.
19905
19906pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
19907 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
19908 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
19909 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
19910
19911 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
19912 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
19913 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
19914 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
19915
19916 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
19917 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
19918
19919path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010019920 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010019921 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
19922 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
19923 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
19924 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
19925 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
19926 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
19927 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010019928
19929 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019930 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010019931 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
19932 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
19933 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
19934 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019935
19936 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010019937 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
19938 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019939
19940option get-values
19941no option get-values
19942 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
19943
19944 HAproxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
19945 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
19946
19947 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
19948 application will accept.
19949
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020019950 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
19951 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019952
19953 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050019954 the connection immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020019955 option is disabled.
19956
19957 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
19958 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
19959 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
19960 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
19961 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
19962 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
19963
19964option keep-conn
19965no option keep-conn
19966 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
19967 sending a response.
19968
19969 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
19970 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
19971
19972option max-reqs <reqs>
19973 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
19974 accept.
19975
19976 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
19977 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
19978 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
19979 to 1.
19980
19981option mpxs-conns
19982no option mpxs-conns
19983 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
19984
19985 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
19986 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
19987
19988set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
19989 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
19990 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
19991 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
19992 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
19993
19994 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
19995 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
19996 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
19997
19998 Example :
19999 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
20000 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
20001
20002 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
20003
20004
2000510.1.2. Proxy section
20006---------------------
20007
20008use-fcgi-app <name>
20009 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
20010
20011 Arguments :
20012 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
20013
20014 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
20015 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
20016 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
20017 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
20018 application may be defined at a time per backend.
20019
20020 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
20021 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
20022 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
20023 application are evaluated.
20024
20025
2002610.1.3. Example
20027---------------
20028
20029 frontend front-http
20030 mode http
20031 bind *:80
20032 bind *:
20033
20034 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
20035 default_backend back-static
20036
20037 backend back-static
20038 mode http
20039 server www A.B.C.D:80
20040
20041 backend back-dynamic
20042 mode http
20043 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
20044 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
20045
20046 fcgi-app php-fpm
20047 log-stderr global
20048 option keep-conn
20049
20050 docroot /var/www/my-app
20051 index index.php
20052 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
20053
20054
2005510.2. Default parameters
20056------------------------
20057
20058A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
20059the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020060script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020020061applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
20062
20063 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20064 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
20065 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
20066 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
20067 | | |
20068 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20069 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
20070 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
20071 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
20072 | | application. |
20073 | | |
20074 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20075 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
20076 | | the request. It may not be set. |
20077 | | |
20078 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20079 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
20080 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
20081 | | the application's configuration. |
20082 | | |
20083 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20084 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
20085 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
20086 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
20087 | | |
20088 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20089 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
20090 | | following the part that identifies the script |
20091 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
20092 | | be defined. |
20093 | | |
20094 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20095 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
20096 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
20097 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
20098 | | is not set too. |
20099 | | |
20100 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20101 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
20102 | | set. |
20103 | | |
20104 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20105 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
20106 | | the request. |
20107 | | |
20108 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20109 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
20110 | | client as part of user authentication. |
20111 | | |
20112 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20113 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
20114 | | script to process the request. |
20115 | | |
20116 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20117 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
20118 | | |
20119 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20120 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
20121 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
20122 | | |
20123 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20124 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
20125 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
20126 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
20127 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
20128 | | |
20129 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20130 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
20131 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
20132 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
20133 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
20134 | | side. |
20135 | | |
20136 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20137 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
20138 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
20139 | | connected to. |
20140 | | |
20141 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20142 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
20143 | | |
20144 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20145 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
20146 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
20147 | | |
20148 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
20149
20150
2015110.3. Limitations
20152------------------
20153
20154The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
20155way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
20156during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
20157establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
20158application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
20159or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
20160message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
20161these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
20162and HTTP servers under the same backend.
20163
20164Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
20165request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
20166requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
20167
20168About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
20169into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
20170fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
20171"http-request" ones.
20172
20173Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
20174FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
20175processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
20176must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
20177here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010020178
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010020179/*
20180 * Local variables:
20181 * fill-column: 79
20182 * End:
20183 */